blob: 208092863c18165f0635064aa1443880bba7175d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaueab1dc62013-06-17 15:10:25 +02007 2013/06/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
727.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
737.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
757.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
767.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078
798. Logging
808.1. Log levels
818.2. Log formats
828.2.1. Default log format
838.2.2. TCP log format
848.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100858.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100868.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200878.3. Advanced logging options
888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
898.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
928.4. Timing events
938.5. Session state at disconnection
948.6. Non-printable characters
958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
978.9. Examples of logs
98
999. Statistics and monitoring
1009.1. CSV format
1019.2. Unix Socket commands
102
103
1041. Quick reminder about HTTP
105----------------------------
106
107When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
108fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
109on almost anything found in the contents.
110
111However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
112formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
113correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
114
115
1161.1. The HTTP transaction model
117-------------------------------
118
119The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100120to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
122connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
123will involve a new connection :
124
125 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
126
127In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
128establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
129by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
130length.
131
132Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
133to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
134however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
135response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
136header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
137
138 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
139
140Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
141power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
142but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200143a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144
145A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
146keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
147second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
148page :
149
150 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
151
152This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
153latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
154correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
155the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100156server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
159connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
160everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
161established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
162sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
163while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
164another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
165sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
166http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
167mode.
168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
1701.2. HTTP request
171-----------------
172
173First, let's consider this HTTP request :
174
175 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100176 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
178 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
179 3 User-agent: my small browser
180 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
181 5 Accept: image/png
182
183
1841.2.1. The Request line
185-----------------------
186
187Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
188
189 - a METHOD : GET
190 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
191 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
192
193All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
194which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
195followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
196is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
197desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
198the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
199
200The URI itself can have several forms :
201
202 - A "relative URI" :
203
204 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
207 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
208
209 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
210
211 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
212
213 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
214 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
215 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
216 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
217 must accept this form too.
218
219 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
220 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
221 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
224 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
225 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
226 other protocols too.
227
228In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
229mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
230on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
231It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
232specific to the language, framework or application in use.
233
234
2351.2.2. The request headers
236--------------------------
237
238The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
239beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
240an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
241Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
242values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
243encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
244the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
245define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
246
247Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
248their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
249"Connection:" header).
250
251The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
252that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
253is one valid form of empty line.
254
255Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
256headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
257about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
258application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
259
260Important note:
261 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
262 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
263 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
264 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
265
266
2671.3. HTTP response
268------------------
269
270An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
271messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
272
273 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100274 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
276 2 Content-length: 350
277 3 Content-Type: text/html
278
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200279As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
280codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
281response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100282continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
283the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
284following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
285sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
286(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
287correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
288such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
289state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
290over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
291if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
292information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
2951.3.1. The Response line
296------------------------
297
298Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
299
300 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
301 - a status code : 200
302 - a reason : OK
303
304The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200305 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
307 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
308 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
309 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
310
311Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
314messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
315or "Authentication Required".
316
317Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
318
319 Code When / reason
320 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
321 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
322 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
323 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100324 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 400 for an invalid or too large request
327 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
328 accessing the stats page)
329 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
330 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
331 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
332 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
333 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
334 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
335 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
336 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
337 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
338
339The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3404.2).
341
342
3431.3.2. The response headers
344---------------------------
345
346Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
347the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
348details.
349
350
3512. Configuring HAProxy
352----------------------
353
3542.1. Configuration file format
355------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200356
357HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
358
359 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
360 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
361 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
362 "frontend" and "backend".
363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
365referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
366delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368escaped by doubling them.
369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370
3712.2. Time format
372----------------
373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100374Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
376otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
377numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
378for every keyword. Supported units are :
379
380 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
381 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
382 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
383 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
384 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
385 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
386
387
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003882.3. Examples
389-------------
390
391 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
392 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
393 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
394 global
395 daemon
396 maxconn 256
397
398 defaults
399 mode http
400 timeout connect 5000ms
401 timeout client 50000ms
402 timeout server 50000ms
403
404 frontend http-in
405 bind *:80
406 default_backend servers
407
408 backend servers
409 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
410
411
412 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
413 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
414 global
415 daemon
416 maxconn 256
417
418 defaults
419 mode http
420 timeout connect 5000ms
421 timeout client 50000ms
422 timeout server 50000ms
423
424 listen http-in
425 bind *:80
426 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
427
428
429Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
430
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100431 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432
433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200435--------------------
436
437Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
438are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
439of them have command-line equivalents.
440
441The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
442
443 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200444 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200446 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 - daemon
448 - gid
449 - group
450 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100451 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - nbproc
453 - pidfile
454 - uid
455 - ulimit-n
456 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200457 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200458 - node
459 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100460 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200462 * Performance tuning
463 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200464 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100465 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100466 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100467 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200468 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - noepoll
470 - nokqueue
471 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200473 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200474 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200475 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100476 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100477 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200478 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100479 - tune.maxaccept
480 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200482 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100483 - tune.rcvbuf.client
484 - tune.rcvbuf.server
485 - tune.sndbuf.client
486 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100487 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100488 - tune.ssl.lifetime
489 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100490 - tune.zlib.memlevel
491 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493 * Debugging
494 - debug
495 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200496
497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004983.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499------------------------------------
500
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200501ca-base <dir>
502 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200503 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
504 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506chroot <jail dir>
507 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
508 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
509 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
510 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
511 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
512 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100513
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100514cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
515 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
516 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
517 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
518 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
519 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
520 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
521 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
522 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
523 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
524 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
525 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
526 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
527 they overlap.
528
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529crt-base <dir>
530 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
531 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
532 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200534daemon
535 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
536 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
537 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
538
539gid <number>
540 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
541 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
542 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100543 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
544 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100546
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547group <group name>
548 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
549 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100550
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200551log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
553 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100554 configured with "log global".
555
556 <address> can be one of:
557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100558 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100559 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
560 port).
561
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100562 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
563 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
564 port).
565
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100566 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
567 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
568 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
569 writeable).
570
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100571 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
572 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
573 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
574 in Bourne shell.
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577
578 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
579 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
580 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
581
582 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200583 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
584 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
585 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
586 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
587 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
588 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200590 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100592log-send-hostname [<string>]
593 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
594 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
595 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
596 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
597 the logs.
598
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000599log-tag <string>
600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
601 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
602 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
603 running on the same host.
604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605nbproc <number>
606 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
607 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
608 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
609 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
610 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
611
612pidfile <pidfile>
613 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
614 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
615 starting the process. See also "daemon".
616
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100617stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200618 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
619 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
620 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
621 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
622 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
623 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
624 the number of processes used.
625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200626stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
627 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
628 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
629 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
630 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200631
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200632 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
633 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
634 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200635
636stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
637 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
638 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100639 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200640
641stats maxconn <connections>
642 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
643 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645uid <number>
646 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
647 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
648 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
649 one. See also "gid" and "user".
650
651ulimit-n <number>
652 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
653 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
654 option.
655
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100656unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
657 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
658
659 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
660 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
661 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
662 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
663 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
664 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
665 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
666 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
667 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
668 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670user <user name>
671 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
672 See also "uid" and "group".
673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200674node <name>
675 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
676
677 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
678 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
679 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
680 traffic.
681
682description <text>
683 Add a text that describes the instance.
684
685 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
686 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
687 "<" and ">" characters.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006903.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691-----------------------
692
693maxconn <number>
694 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
695 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
696 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
697 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200699maxconnrate <number>
700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
707 fairness.
708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100709maxcomprate <number>
710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
711 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
716 default value.
717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100718maxcompcpuusage <number>
719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728maxpipes <number>
729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
735
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200736maxsslconn <number>
737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
738 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
739 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
740 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
741 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
742 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
743 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
744
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100745maxzlibmem <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
747 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
748 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100749 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
750 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
751 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
752
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753noepoll
754 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
755 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100756 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
758nokqueue
759 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
760 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
761 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
762
763nopoll
764 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
765 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100766 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100767 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769nosplice
770 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
771 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
772 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100773 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100774 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
775 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
776 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
777 "option splice-response".
778
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200779spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900780 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
781 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
782 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
783 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
784 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
785 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200786
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200787tune.bufsize <number>
788 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
789 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
790 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
791 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
792 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
793 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
794 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
795 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400796 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
797 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
798 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200799
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200800tune.chksize <number>
801 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
802 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
803 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
804 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
805 checks whenever possible.
806
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100807tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
808 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
809 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
810 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
811 this value. The default value is 1.
812
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100813tune.http.cookielen <number>
814 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
815 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
816 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
817 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
818 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
819 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
820 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
821 to change this value.
822
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200823tune.http.maxhdr <number>
824 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
825 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
826 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
827 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
828 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
829 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
830 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
831 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
832 limit too high.
833
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100834tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100835 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
836 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
837 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
838 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
839 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
840 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
841 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
842 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
843 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
844 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100845
846tune.maxpollevents <number>
847 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
848 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
849 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
850 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
851 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
852
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200853tune.maxrewrite <number>
854 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
855 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
856 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
857 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
858 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
859 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
860 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
861 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
862 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
863 bufsize.
864
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200865tune.pipesize <number>
866 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
867 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
868 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
869 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
870 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
871 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
872
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100873tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
874tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
875 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
876 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
877 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
878 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
879 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
880 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
881 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
882
883tune.sndbuf.client <number>
884tune.sndbuf.server <number>
885 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
886 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
887 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
888 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
889 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
890 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
891 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
892 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
893 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
894 notifying haproxy again.
895
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100896tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100897 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
898 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
899 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
900 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block use approximatively
901 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
902 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
903 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
904 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
905 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100906 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
907 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100908
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100909tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
910 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
911 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 mn). It is important to understand that it
912 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
913 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
914 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
915 being used for too long.
916
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100917tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
918 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
919 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
920 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
921 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
922 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
923 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
924 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
925 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
926 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
927 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
928 best value.
929
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100930tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
931 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
932 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
933 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
934 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
935 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
936
937tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
938 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
939 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
940 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
941 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009433.3. Debugging
944--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946debug
947 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
948 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
949 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
950 system startup.
951
952quiet
953 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
954 line argument "-q".
955
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01009573.4. Userlists
958--------------
959It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
960http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
961it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
962
963userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100964 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100965 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
966
967group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100968 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100969 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
970 proceeded by "users" keyword.
971
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100972user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
973 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100974 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
975 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100976 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
977 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100978 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
979 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
980
981
982 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100983 userlist L1
984 group G1 users tiger,scott
985 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100987 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
988 user scott insecure-password elgato
989 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100990
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100991 userlist L2
992 group G1
993 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100994
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100995 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
996 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
997 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100998
999 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001000
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001001
10023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001003----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001004It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1005haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1006pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1007identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1008or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1009Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1010known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1011the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1012process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1013during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1014tables.
1015
1016peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001017 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001018 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1019
1020peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1021 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1022 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1023 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1024 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1025 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1026 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1027
1028 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1029 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1030
1031 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1032 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1033 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1034 across all peers.
1035
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001036 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1037 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1038 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1039
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001040 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001041 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001042 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1043 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1044 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001045
1046 backend mybackend
1047 mode tcp
1048 balance roundrobin
1049 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1050 stick on src
1051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001052 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1053 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001054
1055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010564. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001058
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001059Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1060 - defaults <name>
1061 - frontend <name>
1062 - backend <name>
1063 - listen <name>
1064
1065A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1066its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1067section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001068section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
1070A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1071connections.
1072
1073A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1074to forward incoming connections.
1075
1076A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1077parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1080'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1081case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1082
1083Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1084logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1085proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1086However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1087name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1088
1089Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1090and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001091bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001092protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1093modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1094arbitrary criteria.
1095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1098--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001100The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1101limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1102they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1103limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001104marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001105option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001106and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1107with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1108specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001111 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1112------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1113acl - X X X
1114appsession - - X X
1115backlog X X X -
1116balance X - X X
1117bind - X X -
1118bind-process X X X X
1119block - X X X
1120capture cookie - X X -
1121capture request header - X X -
1122capture response header - X X -
1123clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001124compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001125contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1126cookie X - X X
1127default-server X - X X
1128default_backend X X X -
1129description - X X X
1130disabled X X X X
1131dispatch - - X X
1132enabled X X X X
1133errorfile X X X X
1134errorloc X X X X
1135errorloc302 X X X X
1136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1137errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001138force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139fullconn X - X X
1140grace X X X X
1141hash-type X - X X
1142http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001143http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001144http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001145http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001146http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001147tcp-check expect - - X X
1148tcp-check send - - X X
1149tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001150http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001152ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001153log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001154maxconn X X X -
1155mode X X X X
1156monitor fail - X X -
1157monitor-net X X X -
1158monitor-uri X X X -
1159option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1160option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1161option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1162option allbackups (*) X - X X
1163option checkcache (*) X - X X
1164option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1165option contstats (*) X X X -
1166option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1167option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1168option forceclose (*) X X X X
1169-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1170option forwardfor X X X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001171option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001172option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001173option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001174option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1175option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1176option httpchk X - X X
1177option httpclose (*) X X X X
1178option httplog X X X X
1179option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001180option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001181option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001182option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1183option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1184option logasap (*) X X X -
1185option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001186option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001187option nolinger (*) X X X X
1188option originalto X X X X
1189option persist (*) X - X X
1190option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001191option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001192option smtpchk X - X X
1193option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1194option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1195option splice-request (*) X X X X
1196option splice-response (*) X X X X
1197option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1198option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1199-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1200option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1201option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1202option tcpka X X X X
1203option tcplog X X X X
1204option transparent (*) X - X X
1205persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1206rate-limit sessions X X X -
1207redirect - X X X
1208redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1209redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1210reqadd - X X X
1211reqallow - X X X
1212reqdel - X X X
1213reqdeny - X X X
1214reqiallow - X X X
1215reqidel - X X X
1216reqideny - X X X
1217reqipass - X X X
1218reqirep - X X X
1219reqisetbe - X X X
1220reqitarpit - X X X
1221reqpass - X X X
1222reqrep - X X X
1223-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1224reqsetbe - X X X
1225reqtarpit - X X X
1226retries X - X X
1227rspadd - X X X
1228rspdel - X X X
1229rspdeny - X X X
1230rspidel - X X X
1231rspideny - X X X
1232rspirep - X X X
1233rsprep - X X X
1234server - - X X
1235source X - X X
1236srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001237stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238stats auth X - X X
1239stats enable X - X X
1240stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001241stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001242stats realm X - X X
1243stats refresh X - X X
1244stats scope X - X X
1245stats show-desc X - X X
1246stats show-legends X - X X
1247stats show-node X - X X
1248stats uri X - X X
1249-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1250stick match - - X X
1251stick on - - X X
1252stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001253stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001254stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001255tcp-request connection - X X -
1256tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001257tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001258tcp-response content - - X X
1259tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001260timeout check X - X X
1261timeout client X X X -
1262timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1263timeout connect X - X X
1264timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1265timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1266timeout http-request X X X X
1267timeout queue X - X X
1268timeout server X - X X
1269timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1270timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001271timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001272transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001273unique-id-format X X X -
1274unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001275use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001276use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001277------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1278 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012814.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1282---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001283
1284This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1285
1286
1287acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1288 Declare or complete an access list.
1289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1290 no | yes | yes | yes
1291 Example:
1292 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1293 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1294 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001297
1298
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001299appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1300 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001301 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1303 no | no | yes | yes
1304 Arguments :
1305 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1306 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1307
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001308 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 checked in each cookie value.
1310
1311 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1312 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1313 milliseconds.
1314
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001315 request-learn
1316 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1317 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1318 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1319 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1320 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1321 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1322
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001323 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1324 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1325 data following this prefix.
1326
1327 Example :
1328 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1329
1330 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1331 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1332
1333 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1334 2 modes are currently supported :
1335 - path-parameters :
1336 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1337 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1338 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1339 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1340 - query-string :
1341 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1342 query string.
1343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1345 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1346 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1347 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001348 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1349 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1350 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001351 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1352 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1353
1354 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1355
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001356 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1357 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1358 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1359
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001360 Example :
1361 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1362
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001363 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1364 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001365
1366
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001367backlog <conns>
1368 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1370 yes | yes | yes | no
1371 Arguments :
1372 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1373 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001374 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001375
1376 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1377 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1378 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1379 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1380 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1381 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1382 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1383 backlog parameter.
1384
1385 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1386 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1387 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1388
1389 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1390
1391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001392balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001393balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1396 yes | no | yes | yes
1397 Arguments :
1398 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1399 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1400 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1401 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1402
1403 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1404 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1405 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1406 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001407 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001408 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001409 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1410 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1411 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1412 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1413 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1414 it, so that you don't worry.
1415
1416 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1417 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1418 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1419 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1420 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1421 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1422 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1423 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001425 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1426 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1427 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1428 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1429 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1430 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1431 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1432 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1433
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001434 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1435 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1436 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1437 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001438 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001439 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1440 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1441 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1442 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1443 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001444 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1445 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1446 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1447 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1448 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1449 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001450
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001451 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1452 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1453 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1454 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1455 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1456 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1457 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1458 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001459 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001460 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001461 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1462 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1463 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001465 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1466 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1467 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1468 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1469 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1470 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1471 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1472 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1473 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1474 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1475 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1476 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001478 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001479 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1480 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1481 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1482 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1483 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1484 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1485 URIs start with a leading "/".
1486
1487 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1488 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1489 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1490 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001493 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1494
1495 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001496 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1497 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1498 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1499 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1500 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1501 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1502 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1503 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1504 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1505 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1506 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1507 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1508 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1509 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1510 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1511 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1512 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1513 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1514 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001515
1516 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1517 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1518 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1519 server will receive the request.
1520
1521 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1522 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1523 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1524 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1525 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001526 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1527 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1528 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001530 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1531 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1532 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1533 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1534 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001536 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001537 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1538 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1539 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1540
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001541 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1542 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1543 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1544
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001545 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001546 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001547 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1548 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1549 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1550 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1551 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1552 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001554 used instead.
1555
1556 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1557 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1558 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1559 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1560
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001561 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1562 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1563 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1564
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001565 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001567 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001568 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1569 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001570
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001571 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001572 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001574 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1575 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1576 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577
1578 Examples :
1579 balance roundrobin
1580 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001581 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001582 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1583 balance hdr(host)
1584 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001585
1586 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1587 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001589 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001590 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1591 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1592 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1593 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1594
1595 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1596 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1597 defaults to 16 kB.
1598
1599 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1600 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1601
1602 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1603 Round Robin.
1604
1605 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1606 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1607 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1608 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1609
1610 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1611
1612 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001613 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001614 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1615 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1616 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001618 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1619 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620
1621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001622bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1623bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1626 no | yes | yes | no
1627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001628 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1629 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1630 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1631 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001632 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001633 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1634 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1635 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1636 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1637 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1638 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1639 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001640 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1641 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1642 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001643 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1644 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1645 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1646 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001647
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001648 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1649 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001650 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1651 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1652 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001653 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1654 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1655 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1656 the range.
1657
1658 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1659 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1660 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1661 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1662 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1663 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1664 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001665 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001666 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001667
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001668 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1669 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1670 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1671 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1672 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1673 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1674 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1675 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001677 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1678 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1679 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1680 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1683 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1684 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1685 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1686 in a frontend.
1687
1688 Example :
1689 listen http_proxy
1690 bind :80,:443
1691 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001692 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001693
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001694 listen http_https_proxy
1695 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001696 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001697
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001698 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1699 bind ipv6@:80
1700 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1701 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1702
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001703 listen external_bind_app1
1704 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1705
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001706 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001707 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708
1709
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001710bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001711 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1713 yes | yes | yes | yes
1714 Arguments :
1715 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1716 may be used to override a default value.
1717
1718 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1719 option may be combined with other numbers.
1720
1721 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1722 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1723 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1724 missing from all processes.
1725
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001726 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1727 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1728 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1729 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1730 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001731
1732 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1733 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1734 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1735 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1736 and 'even' instances.
1737
1738 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1739 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1740 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1741 32.
1742
1743 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1744 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1745
1746 Example :
1747 listen app_ip1
1748 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001749 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001750
1751 listen app_ip2
1752 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001753 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001754
1755 listen management
1756 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001757 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001758
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001759 listen management
1760 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1761 bind-process 1-4
1762
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001763 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1764
1765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001766block { if | unless } <condition>
1767 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1769 no | yes | yes | yes
1770
1771 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1772 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001773 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001774 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1776 "block" statements per instance.
1777
1778 Example:
1779 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1780 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1781 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1782 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1783
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001784 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
1786
1787capture cookie <name> len <length>
1788 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1790 no | yes | yes | no
1791 Arguments :
1792 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1793 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1794 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1795 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1796 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1797
1798 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1799 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1800 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1801 right if it exceeds <length>.
1802
1803 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1804 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1805 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1806 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1807
1808 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1809 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1810 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1811
1812 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1813 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1814 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001815 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1816 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1817 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
1819 Example:
1820 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1821
1822 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001823 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001824
1825
1826capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001827 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 no | yes | yes | no
1830 Arguments :
1831 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001832 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1834 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1835 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1836
1837 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1838 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1839 it exceeds <length>.
1840
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001841 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1843 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001844 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1845 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1846 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1847 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001848 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001849 environments to find where the request came from.
1850
1851 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1852 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1853 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1854 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001856 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1857 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1858 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1859 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1860 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
1862 Example:
1863 capture request header Host len 15
1864 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1865 capture request header Referrer len 15
1866
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001867 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868 about logging.
1869
1870
1871capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001872 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1874 no | yes | yes | no
1875 Arguments :
1876 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001877 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1879 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1880 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1881
1882 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1883 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1884 it exceeds <length>.
1885
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001886 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1888 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1889 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001890 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1891 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1892 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1893 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001895 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1896 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1897 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1898 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1899 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001900
1901 Example:
1902 capture response header Content-length len 9
1903 capture response header Location len 15
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906 about logging.
1907
1908
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001909clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 yes | yes | yes | no
1913 Arguments :
1914 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1916 as explained at the top of this document.
1917
1918 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1919 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1920 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1921 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1922 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1923 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1924 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1925 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001926 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001927 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1928 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1929
1930 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1931 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1932 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1933 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1934 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1935 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1936
1937 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1938 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1939
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001940 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1941 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001943compression algo <algorithm> ...
1944compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001945compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001946 Enable HTTP compression.
1947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1948 yes | yes | yes | yes
1949 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001950 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1951 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1952 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1953
1954 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001955 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001956 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1957 data.
1958
1959 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1960 support for zlib was built in.
1961
1962 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1963 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1964 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1965 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1966 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1967 in.
1968
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04001969 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001970 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001971 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
1972 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
1973 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
1974 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
1975 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001976
1977 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1978 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1979 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1980 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1981 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04001982 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
1983 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
1984 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
1985 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
1986 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
1987 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001988
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01001989 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001990 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
1991 "Accept-Encoding" header
1992 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01001993 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01001994 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
1995 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01001996 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
1997 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
1998 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
1999 "multipart"
2000 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2001 header
2002 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2003 and later
2004 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2005 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002006
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002007 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2008 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002009
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002010 Examples :
2011 compression algo gzip
2012 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002014contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002015 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2017 yes | no | yes | yes
2018 Arguments :
2019 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2020 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2021 as explained at the top of this document.
2022
2023 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002024 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002025 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2027 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2028 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2029 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2030
2031 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2032 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2033 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2034 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2035 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2036 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2037
2038 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2039 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2040 instead.
2041
2042 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2043 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2044
2045
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002046cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002047 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2048 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2051 yes | no | yes | yes
2052 Arguments :
2053 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2054 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2055 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2056 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2057 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2058 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2059 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2060 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2061 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2062
2063 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2064 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2065 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2066 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2067 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2068 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2069 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2070 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2071 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2072 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2073 "insert" and "prefix".
2074
2075 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002076 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002077
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002078 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002079 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2080 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2081 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2082 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2083 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2084 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2085 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2086 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2087 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2088 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
2090 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2091 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2092 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2093 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2094 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2095 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2096 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2097 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2098 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2099 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002100 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2101 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2102 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002104 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2105 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2106 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002107 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2108 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2109 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2110 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002111 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2112 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2113 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114
2115 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2116 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2117 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2118 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2119 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2120 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2121 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2122 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2123 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2124
2125 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2126 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2127 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2128 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2129 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2130 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2131 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2132 persistence cookie in the cache.
2133 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2134
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002135 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2136 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2137 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2138 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2139 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2140 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2141 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2142 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2143 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2144 they logout.
2145
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002146 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2147 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2148 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2149 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2150
2151 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2152 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2153 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2154 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2155 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2156 this attribute.
2157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002158 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002159 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002160 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2161 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2162 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2163 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2164 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2165 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002166
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002167 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2168 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2169 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2170 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2171 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2172 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2173 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2174 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2175 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2176 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2177 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2178 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2179 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2180 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2181 the site.
2182
2183 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2184 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2185 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2186 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2187 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2188 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2189 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2190 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2191 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2192 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2193 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2194 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2195 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2196 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2197 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2198 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2201 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2202 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2203 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 Examples :
2206 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2207 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2208 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002209 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002211 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002212 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002213
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002215default-server [param*]
2216 Change default options for a server in a backend
2217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2218 yes | no | yes | yes
2219 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002220 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2221 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2222 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2223 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002224
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002225 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002226 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2227
2228 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002229
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002231default_backend <backend>
2232 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2234 yes | yes | yes | no
2235 Arguments :
2236 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2237
2238 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2239 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2240 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2241 will catch all undetermined requests.
2242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243 Example :
2244
2245 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2246 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2247 default_backend dynamic
2248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002249 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002252description <string>
2253 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2255 no | yes | yes | yes
2256 Arguments : string
2257
2258 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2259 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2260 it describes.
2261 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2262
2263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002264disabled
2265 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2267 yes | yes | yes | yes
2268 Arguments : none
2269
2270 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2271 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2272 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2273 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2274 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2275 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2276 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2277
2278 See also : "enabled"
2279
2280
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002281dispatch <address>:<port>
2282 Set a default server address
2283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2284 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002285 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002286
2287 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2288 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2289 during start-up.
2290
2291 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2292 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2293 possible with normal servers.
2294
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002295 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002296 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2297 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2298 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2299 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2300
2301 See also : "server"
2302
2303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002304enabled
2305 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2307 yes | yes | yes | yes
2308 Arguments : none
2309
2310 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2311 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2312
2313 See also : "disabled"
2314
2315
2316errorfile <code> <file>
2317 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2319 yes | yes | yes | yes
2320 Arguments :
2321 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002322 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002325 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002327 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2328 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
2330 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2331 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2332 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2333
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002334 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2337 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2338 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2339 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2340
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002341 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2342 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2343 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2344 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2345 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2346 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2349 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2350 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002351 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2353
2354 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2355
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002356 Example :
2357 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2358 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2359 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002361
2362errorloc <code> <url>
2363errorloc302 <code> <url>
2364 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | yes
2367 Arguments :
2368 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002369 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002370
2371 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2372 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2373 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2374 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2375 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2376
2377 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2378 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2379 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2380
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002381 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002383 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2384 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2385 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2386 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2387 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2388 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2389 request.
2390
2391 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2392
2393
2394errorloc303 <code> <url>
2395 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2397 yes | yes | yes | yes
2398 Arguments :
2399 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2400 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2401
2402 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2403 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2404 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2405 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2406 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2407
2408 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2409 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2410 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2411
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002412 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002414 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2415 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2416 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2417 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002418 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002419
2420 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2421
2422
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002423force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2424 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2426 no | yes | yes | yes
2427
2428 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2429 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2430 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2431 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2432 marked down for maintenance operations.
2433
2434 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2435 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2436 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2437 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2438 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2439 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2440 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2441 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2442 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2443
2444 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2445 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2446 is used.
2447
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002448 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002449 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002450
2451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002452fullconn <conns>
2453 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2455 yes | no | yes | yes
2456 Arguments :
2457 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2458 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2459
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002460 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002461 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002462 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2464 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2465 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2466 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2467 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002468 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002469
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002470 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2471 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2472 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2473
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002474 Example :
2475 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2476 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2477 # connections.
2478 backend dynamic
2479 fullconn 10000
2480 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2481 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2482
2483 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2484
2485
2486grace <time>
2487 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002489 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002490 Arguments :
2491 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2492 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2493 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2494
2495 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2496 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002497 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002498 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2499
2500 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2501 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2502 simplify it.
2503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002505hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002506 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2508 yes | no | yes | yes
2509 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002510 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2511 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002512
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002513 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2514 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2515 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2516 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2517 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2518 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2519 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2520 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2521 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2522 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002523
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002524 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2525 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2526 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2527 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2528 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2529 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2530 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2531 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2532 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2533 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2534 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2535 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2536 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002537 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2538 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002539
2540 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2541
2542 sdbm this function was created intially for sdbm (a public-domain
2543 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2544 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2545 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002546 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2547 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2548 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002549
2550 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2551 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002552 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2553 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2554 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2555 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2556
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002557 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2558 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2559 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2560 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2561 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2562 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2563 parameter.
2564
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002565 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2566
2567 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2568 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2569 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2570 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2571 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2572 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2573 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2574 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2575 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2576 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2577 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2578 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002579
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002580 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2581 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2582 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002583
2584 See also : "balance", "server"
2585
2586
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587http-check disable-on-404
2588 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591 Arguments : none
2592
2593 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2594 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2595 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2596 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2597 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2598 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2599 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2600 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002601 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2602 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2603 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2604
2605 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2606
2607
2608http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002609 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002611 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002612 Arguments :
2613 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2614 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002615 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002616 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2617 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2618 details on the supported keywords.
2619
2620 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2621 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2622 with the usual backslash ('\').
2623
2624 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2625 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2626 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2627 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2628 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2629
2630 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002631 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002632 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2633 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2634 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2635
2636 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002638 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2639 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2640 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2641 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2642
2643 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002644 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002645 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2646 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2647 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2648 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2649 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2650 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2651 trace).
2652
2653 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002654 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002655 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2656 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2657 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2658 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2659 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2660 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2661
2662 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2663 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2664 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2665 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2666 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2667 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2668 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2669 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2670
2671 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2672 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2673
2674 Examples :
2675 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002676 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002677
2678 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002679 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002680
2681 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002682 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002683
2684 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002685 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002687 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002688
2689
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002690http-check send-state
2691 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2693 yes | no | yes | yes
2694 Arguments : none
2695
2696 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2697 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2698 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2699 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2700 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2701
2702 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2703 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2704 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2705 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2706 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2707 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2708 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2709 checked in multiple backends.
2710
2711 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2712 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2713
2714 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2715 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2716 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2717 one fails.
2718
2719 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2720 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2721 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2722
2723 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2724 server's queue.
2725
2726 Example of a header received by the application server :
2727 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2728 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2729
2730 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2731
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002732http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002733 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002734 set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> | set-tos <tos> |
2735 set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002736 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002737 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2738
2739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 no | yes | yes | yes
2741
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002742 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2743 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2744 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2745 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2746 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002747
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002748 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2749 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2750 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2751
2752 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2753 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2754 are evaluated.
2755
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002756 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2757 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2758 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2759 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2760 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2761 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2762 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2763 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2764 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
2765 developped robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
2766 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2767
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002768 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2769 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2770 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2771 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2772 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2773
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002774 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2775 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2776 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002777 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2778 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002779
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002780 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2781 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2782 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2783 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2784 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2785 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2786 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2787 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2788
2789 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2790 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2791 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2792 external users.
2793
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002794 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2795 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2796 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2797 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2798 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2799 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2800 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2801 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2802
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002803 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2804 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2805 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2806 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2807 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2808 another equipment.
2809
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002810 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2811 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2812 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2813 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2814 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2815 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2816 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2817 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2818
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002819 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2820 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2821 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2822 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2823 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2824 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2825 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2826 admin privileges.
2827
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002828 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2829
2830 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2831 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2832 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2833 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002834
2835 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002836 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2837 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2838 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002839
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002840 http-request allow if nagios
2841 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2842 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2843 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002844
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002845 Example:
2846 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002847 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002848
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002849 Example:
2850 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2851 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2852 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2853 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2854 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2855 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2856 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2857 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2858 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2859
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002860 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2861 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002862
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002863http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002864 set-header <name> <fmt> | set-log-level <level> |
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002865 set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
2866 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002867 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2868
2869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2870 no | yes | yes | yes
2871
2872 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2873 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2874 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2875 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2876 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2877 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2878
2879 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2880 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2881 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2882 current section.
2883
2884 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2885 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2886 rules are evaluated.
2887
2888 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2889 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2890 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2891 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2892 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
2893 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
2894 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
2895
2896 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2897 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2898 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2899 external users.
2900
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002901 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2902 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2903 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2904 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2905 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2906 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2907 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2908 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2909
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002910 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2911 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2912 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2913 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2914 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2915 another equipment.
2916
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002917 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2918 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2919 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2920 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2921 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2922 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2923 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2924 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2925
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002926 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2927 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2928 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2929 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2930 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2931 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2932 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2933 admin privileges.
2934
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002935 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
2936
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08002937 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002938 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
2939 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
2940 rules.
2941
2942 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
2943 ACL usage.
2944
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02002945
2946tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2947 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
2948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2949 no | no | yes | yes
2950
2951 Arguments :
2952 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2953 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
2954 binary.
2955 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
2956 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
2957 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
2958
2959 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2960 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2961 with the usual backslash ('\').
2962 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
2963 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
2964 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
2965 used upper or lower case.
2966
2967
2968 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
2969
2970 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
2971 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2972 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
2973 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2974 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2975 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
2976 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
2977 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
2978
2979 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
2980 A health check response will be considered valid if the
2981 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
2982 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2983 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
2984 expression.
2985
2986 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
2987 in the response buffer. A health check response will
2988 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
2989 this exact hexadecimal string.
2990 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
2991
2992 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2993 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2994 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2995 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
2996 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2997 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2998 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2999 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3000 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3001 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3002 the null character.
3003
3004 Examples :
3005 # perform a POP check
3006 option tcp-check
3007 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3008
3009 # perform an IMAP check
3010 option tcp-check
3011 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3012
3013 # look for the redis master server
3014 option tcp-check
3015 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3016 tcp-check expect +PONG
3017 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3018 tcp-check expect string role:master
3019 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3020 tcp-check expect string +OK
3021
3022
3023 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "http-check expect",
3024 tune.chksize
3025
3026
3027tcp-check send <data>
3028 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3030 no | no | yes | yes
3031
3032 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3033 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3034
3035 Examples :
3036 # look for the redis master server
3037 option tcp-check
3038 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3039 tcp-check expect string role:master
3040
3041 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send-binary",
3042 tune.chksize
3043
3044
3045tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3046 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3047 tcp health check
3048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3049 no | no | yes | yes
3050
3051 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3052 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3053 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3054 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3055 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3056 hexadecimal string.
3057 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3058
3059 Examples :
3060 # redis check in binary
3061 option tcp-check
3062 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3063 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3064
3065
3066 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send",
3067 tune.chksize
3068
3069
3070
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003071http-send-name-header [<header>]
3072 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3073
3074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | no | yes | yes
3076
3077 Arguments :
3078
3079 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3080
3081 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3082 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3083 is added with the header string proved.
3084
3085 See also : "server"
3086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003087id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003088 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 no | yes | yes | yes
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3094 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3095 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003096
3097
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003098ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3099 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3100 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3101 no | yes | yes | yes
3102
3103 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3104 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3105 and running).
3106
3107 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3108 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3109 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3110 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3111 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3112
3113 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3114 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3115
3116 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3117 "unless" condition is met.
3118
3119 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3120
3121
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003122log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003123log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003124no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003125 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003128
3129 Prefix :
3130 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3131 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3132 prefix does not allow arguments.
3133
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003134 Arguments :
3135 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3136 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3137 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3138 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3139 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3140 parameter.
3141
3142 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3143 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3144
3145 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3146 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3147 standard syslog port).
3148
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003149 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3150 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3151 standard syslog port).
3152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003153 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3154 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3155 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3156 appropriately writeable).
3157
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003158 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3159 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3160 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3161 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3162
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003163 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3164
3165 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3166 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3167 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3168
3169 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3170 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3171 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003172 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3173 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3174 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3175 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3176 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003177
3178 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3179
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003180 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3181 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3182 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003183
3184 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3185 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3186 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3187 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3188
3189 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3190 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003191
3192 Example :
3193 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003194 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3195 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003196 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3197
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003198
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003199log-format <string>
3200 Allows you to custom a log line.
3201
3202 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3203
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003204
3205maxconn <conns>
3206 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3211 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3212 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3213 closes.
3214
3215 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3216 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3217 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3218 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3219 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3220 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3221 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3222 properly tuned.
3223
3224 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3225 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3226 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3227
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003228 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3231
3232
3233mode { tcp|http|health }
3234 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | yes
3237 Arguments :
3238 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3239 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3240 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3241 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3242
3243 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3244 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3245 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3246 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3247 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3248
3249 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003250 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3251 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3252 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3253 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3254 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3255 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3256 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003258 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3259 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3260 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003262 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003263 defaults http_instances
3264 mode http
3265
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003266 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003268
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003269monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003270 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3272 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273 Arguments :
3274 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3275 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003276 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003277 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3278 backend and its backup.
3279
3280 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3281 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3282 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3283 servers in a list of backends.
3284
3285 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3286 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3287 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3288 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3289 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3290 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3291 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003292 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3293 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294
3295 Example:
3296 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003297 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3299 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3300 monitor-uri /site_alive
3301 monitor fail if site_dead
3302
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003303 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003304
3305
3306monitor-net <source>
3307 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3309 yes | yes | yes | no
3310 Arguments :
3311 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3312 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3313 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3314 followed by a mask.
3315
3316 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3317 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003318 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3320
3321 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3322 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3323 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3324 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003325 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3326 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3327 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003328
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003329 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3330 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3331 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3332 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3333 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3334 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003335
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003336 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3337 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003338
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003339 Example :
3340 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3341 frontend www
3342 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3343
3344 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3345
3346
3347monitor-uri <uri>
3348 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3350 yes | yes | yes | no
3351 Arguments :
3352 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3353 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3354
3355 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3356 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3357 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3358 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3359 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3360 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3361 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3362 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3363
3364 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3365 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3366 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3367 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3368 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3369 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3370
3371 Example :
3372 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3373 frontend www
3374 mode http
3375 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3376
3377 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003380option abortonclose
3381no option abortonclose
3382 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | no | yes | yes
3385 Arguments : none
3386
3387 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3388 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3389 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3390 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003391 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003392 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3393 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3394 encountered while delivering the response.
3395
3396 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3397 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3398 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3399 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3400 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3401 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003402 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003403 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003404 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003405 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3406 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3407 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3408
3409 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3410 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3411 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3412 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3413 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3414 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3415 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3416 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003417 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003418
3419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3421
3422 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3423
3424
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003425option accept-invalid-http-request
3426no option accept-invalid-http-request
3427 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | yes | yes | no
3430 Arguments : none
3431
3432 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3433 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3434 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3435 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3436 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3437 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3438 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3439 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003440 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3441 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3442 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3443 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3444 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3445 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003446
3447 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3448 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3449 been confirmed.
3450
3451 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3452 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003453 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3454 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003455 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3456
3457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3459
3460 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3461 stats socket.
3462
3463
3464option accept-invalid-http-response
3465no option accept-invalid-http-response
3466 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3472 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3473 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3474 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3475 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3476 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3477 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3478 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3479 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3480
3481 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3482 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3483 been confirmed.
3484
3485 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3486 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3487 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3488 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3489
3490 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3491 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3492
3493 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3494 stats socket.
3495
3496
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003497option allbackups
3498no option allbackups
3499 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3501 yes | no | yes | yes
3502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3505 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3506 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3507 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3508 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3509 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3510 order between the backup servers anymore.
3511
3512 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3513 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3514
3515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3517
3518
3519option checkcache
3520no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003521 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3523 yes | no | yes | yes
3524 Arguments : none
3525
3526 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3527 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003528 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003529 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3530 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003531 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003532
3533 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003534 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003535 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003536 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3537 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003538 to the client are :
3539 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003540 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003541 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003542 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3543 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3544 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3545 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3546 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3547 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3548 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3549 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3550 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3551 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3552 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3553
3554 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003555 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003556 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003557 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3559
3560 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3561 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003562 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003563 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3564
3565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3567
3568
3569option clitcpka
3570no option clitcpka
3571 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 yes | yes | yes | no
3574 Arguments : none
3575
3576 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3577 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3578 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3579 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3580
3581 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3582 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3583 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3584 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3585
3586 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3587 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3588 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3589 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3590 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3591
3592 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3593
3594 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3595 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3596 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3597
3598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3600
3601 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3602
3603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003604option contstats
3605 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 yes | yes | yes | no
3608 Arguments : none
3609
3610 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3611 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3612 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3613 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3614 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3615 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3616 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3617
3618
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003619option dontlog-normal
3620no option dontlog-normal
3621 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | yes | yes | no
3624 Arguments : none
3625
3626 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3627 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3628 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3629 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3630 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3631 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3632 logged.
3633
3634 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3635 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3636 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003638 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003639 logging.
3640
3641
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003642option dontlognull
3643no option dontlognull
3644 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | yes | yes | no
3647 Arguments : none
3648
3649 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3650 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3651 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3652 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3653 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3654 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3655 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3656
3657 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3658 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3659 would not be logged.
3660
3661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003664 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003665
3666
3667option forceclose
3668no option forceclose
3669 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003671 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003672 Arguments : none
3673
3674 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3675 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3676 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3677 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3678 global session times in the logs.
3679
3680 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003681 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003682 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3683 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3684 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3685 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003686
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003687 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3688 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3689 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3690
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003691 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3692 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3693
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003694 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695
3696
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003697option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003698 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | yes | yes | yes
3701 Arguments :
3702 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3703 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003704 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003705 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003706
3707 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3708 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3709 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3710 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3711 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3712 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3713 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003714 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3715 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3716 possible that the client has already brought one.
3717
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003718 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003719 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003720 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3721 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003722 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3723 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003724
3725 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3726 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3727 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3728 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3729 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3730 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3731 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3732
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003733 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3734 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3735 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3736 are under the control of the end-user.
3737
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003738 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003739 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3740 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003741 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3742 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3743 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003744
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003745 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3746 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3747 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3748 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3749 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003750
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003751 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003752 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3753 frontend www
3754 mode http
3755 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3756
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003757 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3758 backend www
3759 mode http
3760 option forwardfor header X-Client
3761
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003762 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3763 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003764
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003765
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003766option tcp-check
3767 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
3768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 yes | no | yes | yes
3770
3771 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
3772 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
3773
3774 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
3775 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
3776 attempt, which remains the default mode.
3777
3778 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentionned : this is
3779 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
3780 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
3781 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
3782 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
3783 only.
3784
3785 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentionned : this is used to test a banner.
3786 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
3787 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
3788 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
3789 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
3790
3791 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentionned : this is
3792 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
3793 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
3794 the maching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
3795 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
3796 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
3797 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
3798 the respective protocols.
3799 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
3800 analysed.
3801
3802 Examples :
3803 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
3804 option tcp-check
3805 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3806
3807 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
3808 option tcp-check
3809 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3810
3811 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
3812 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
3813 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 tims)
3814 option tcp-check
3815 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3816 tcp-check expect +PONG
3817 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3818 tcp-check expect string role:master
3819 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3820 tcp-check expect string +OK
3821
3822 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
3823 (send many headers before analyzing)
3824 option tcp-check
3825 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
3826 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
3827 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
3828 tcp-check send \r\n
3829 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
3830
3831
3832 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
3833
3834
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003835option http-no-delay
3836no option http-no-delay
3837 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840 Arguments : none
3841
3842 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3843 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3844 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3845 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3846 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3847 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3848 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3849 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3850 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3851 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3852 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3853 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3854 affected.
3855
3856 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3857 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3858 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3859 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3860 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3861 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3862 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3863 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3864 latency environments.
3865
3866
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003867option http-pretend-keepalive
3868no option http-pretend-keepalive
3869 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | yes | yes | yes
3872 Arguments : none
3873
3874 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3875 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3876 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3877 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3878 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3879 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3880 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3881 consider the response complete.
3882
3883 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3884 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3885 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3886 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3887 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3888 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3889
3890 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3891 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3892 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3893 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3894 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3895 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3896 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3897
3898 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3899 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003900 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003901 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3902 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003903
3904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3906
3907 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3908
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003909
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003910option http-server-close
3911no option http-server-close
3912 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 yes | yes | yes | yes
3915 Arguments : none
3916
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003917 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3918 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3919 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3920 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3921 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3922 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3923 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3924 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3925 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3926 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3927 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3928 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003929
3930 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3931 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3932 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3933 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003934 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3935 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003936
3937 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3938 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003939 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3940 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3941 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003942
3943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3945
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003946 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3947 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003948
3949
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003950option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003951no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003952 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3954 yes | yes | yes | no
3955 Arguments : none
3956
3957 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3958 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3959 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3960 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3961 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3962 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3963 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3964
3965 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3966 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3967 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3968 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3969 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3970 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3971 request along its whole life.
3972
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003973 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3974 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3975 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3976 front of an existing proxy.
3977
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003978 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3979
3980 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3981 http-server-close".
3982
3983
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003984option httpchk
3985option httpchk <uri>
3986option httpchk <method> <uri>
3987option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3988 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | no | yes | yes
3991 Arguments :
3992 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3993 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3994 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3995 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3996 ones.
3997
3998 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3999 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4000 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4001
4002 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4003 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4004 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4005 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4006 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4007
4008 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4009 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4010 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4011 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4012 the lack of any response.
4013
4014 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4015
4016 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4017 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4018 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4019
4020 Examples :
4021 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4022 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4023 backend https_relay
4024 mode tcp
4025 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4026 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4027
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004028 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4029 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4030 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004031
4032
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004033option httpclose
4034no option httpclose
4035 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | yes | yes | yes
4038 Arguments : none
4039
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004040 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
4041 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
4042 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
4043 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
4044 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
4045 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
4046 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004047
4048 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004049 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004050 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4051 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4052 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4053 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4054 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004055
4056 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4057 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
4058 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004059 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
4060 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061
4062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4064
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004065 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4066 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004067
4068
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004069option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004070 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004073 Arguments :
4074 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4075 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4076 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4077 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4078 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004079
4080 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4081 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4082 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4083 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4084 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4085 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4086 ports.
4087
4088 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4089
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4092 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4093 by default.
4094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004095 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004096
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004097
4098option http_proxy
4099no option http_proxy
4100 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4102 yes | yes | yes | yes
4103 Arguments : none
4104
4105 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4106 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4107 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4108 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4109 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4110
4111 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4112 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4113 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4114 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004115 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004116 be analyzed.
4117
4118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4120
4121 Example :
4122 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4123 backend direct_forward
4124 option httpclose
4125 option http_proxy
4126
4127 See also : "option httpclose"
4128
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004129
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004130option independent-streams
4131no option independent-streams
4132 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | yes
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4138 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4139 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4140 receive data or not.
4141
4142 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4143 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4144 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4145 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4146 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4147 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4148 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4149 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4150 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4151 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4152 socket buffers.
4153
4154 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4155 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4156 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4157 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4158 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4159
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004160 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
4161 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4162 deprecated.
4163
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004164 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004165
4166
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004167option ldap-check
4168 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
4171 Arguments : none
4172
4173 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4174 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4175 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4176 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4177
4178 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4179 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4180
4181 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4182 configure it.
4183
4184 Example :
4185 option ldap-check
4186
4187 See also : "option httpchk"
4188
4189
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004190option log-health-checks
4191no option log-health-checks
4192 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4194 yes | no | yes | yes
4195 Arguments : none
4196
4197 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4198 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4199 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4200 of additional information is limited.
4201
4202 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4203 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4204
4205 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4206
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004207
4208option log-separate-errors
4209no option log-separate-errors
4210 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | yes | yes | no
4213 Arguments : none
4214
4215 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4216 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4217 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4218 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4219 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4220 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4221 provides very important information.
4222
4223 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4224 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4225 error logs.
4226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004227 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004228 logging.
4229
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004230
4231option logasap
4232no option logasap
4233 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4235 yes | yes | yes | no
4236 Arguments : none
4237
4238 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4239 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4240 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4241 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4242 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4243 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4244 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004245 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004246 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4247 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004249 Examples :
4250 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4251 mode http
4252 option httplog
4253 option logasap
4254 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4255
4256 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4257 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4258 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4259 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004261 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004262 logging.
4263
4264
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004265option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4266 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004269 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004270 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4271 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004272
4273 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4274 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4275 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4276 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4277 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4278 in the MySQL table, like this :
4279
4280 USE mysql;
4281 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4282 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4283
4284 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4285 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4286 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4287 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4288 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4289 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4290 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4291 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4292 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4293
4294 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4295 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004296
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004297 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004298
4299 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4300 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4301 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4302 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4303 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4304 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4305
4306 See also: "option httpchk"
4307
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004308option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4309 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | no | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004313 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4314 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01004315
4316 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4317 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4318 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4319 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4320
4321 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004322
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004323option nolinger
4324no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004325 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004328 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004329
4330 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4331 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4332 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4333 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4334 connections.
4335
4336 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4337 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4338 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4339 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4340 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4341 this too.
4342
4343 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4344 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4345 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4346
4347 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4348 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4349 for servers.
4350
4351 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4352 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4353
4354
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004355option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4356 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4358 yes | yes | yes | yes
4359 Arguments :
4360 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4361 matching <network>
4362 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4363 header name.
4364
4365 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4366 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4367 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4368 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4369 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4370 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4371 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4372 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4373 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4374 possible that the client has already brought one.
4375
4376 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4377 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4378 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4379 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4380 header and requires different one.
4381
4382 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4383 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4384 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4385 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4386 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4387 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4388 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4389
4390 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4391 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4392 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4393 both are defined.
4394
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004395 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
4396 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
4397 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
4398 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
4399 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004400
4401 Examples :
4402 # Original Destination address
4403 frontend www
4404 mode http
4405 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4406
4407 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4408 backend www
4409 mode http
4410 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4411
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004412 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4413 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004414
4415
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004416option persist
4417no option persist
4418 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004421 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004422
4423 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4424 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4425 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4426 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4427 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4428 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4429 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4430 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4431 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4432 redirected to another valid server.
4433
4434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4436
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004437 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004438
4439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004440option redispatch
4441no option redispatch
4442 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004445 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004446
4447 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4448 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4449 be able to access the service anymore.
4450
4451 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4452 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4453
4454 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4455 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4456 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004458 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4459 "redisp" keywords.
4460
4461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4463
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004464 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004466
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004467option redis-check
4468 Use redis health checks for server testing
4469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4470 yes | no | yes | yes
4471 Arguments : none
4472
4473 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4474 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4475 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4476 find the "+PONG" response message.
4477
4478 Example :
4479 option redis-check
4480
4481 See also : "option httpchk"
4482
4483
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004484option smtpchk
4485option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4486 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004489 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004490 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4491 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4492 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4493
4494 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4495 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4496 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4497
4498 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4499 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4500 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4501 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4502 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4503 dead server.
4504
4505 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4506 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4507 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4508 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4509
4510 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4511 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4512 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4513 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4514 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4515
4516 Example :
4517 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4518
4519 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004522option socket-stats
4523no option socket-stats
4524
4525 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4527 yes | yes | yes | no
4528
4529 Arguments : none
4530
4531
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004532option splice-auto
4533no option splice-auto
4534 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4536 yes | yes | yes | yes
4537 Arguments : none
4538
4539 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4540 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4541 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4542 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004543 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004544 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4545 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4546 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4547 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4548
4549 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4550 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4551 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4552 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4553 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4554 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4555 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4556 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4557 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4558 keyword.
4559
4560 Example :
4561 option splice-auto
4562
4563 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4564 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4565
4566 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4567 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4568
4569
4570option splice-request
4571no option splice-request
4572 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4574 yes | yes | yes | yes
4575 Arguments : none
4576
4577 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004578 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004579 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4580 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4581 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4582 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4583
4584 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4585
4586 Example :
4587 option splice-request
4588
4589 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4590 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4591
4592 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4593 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4594
4595
4596option splice-response
4597no option splice-response
4598 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | yes | yes | yes
4601 Arguments : none
4602
4603 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004604 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004605 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4606 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4607 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4608 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4609
4610 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4611
4612 Example :
4613 option splice-response
4614
4615 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4616 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4617
4618 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4619 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4620
4621
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004622option srvtcpka
4623no option srvtcpka
4624 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4626 yes | no | yes | yes
4627 Arguments : none
4628
4629 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4630 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4631 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4632 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4633
4634 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4635 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4636 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4637 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4638
4639 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4640 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4641 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4642 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4643 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4644
4645 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4646
4647 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4648 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4649 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4650
4651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4653
4654 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4655
4656
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004657option ssl-hello-chk
4658 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4660 yes | no | yes | yes
4661 Arguments : none
4662
4663 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4664 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4665 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4666 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4667 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4668 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4669 hello message.
4670
4671 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4672 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4673 messages, which is appreciable.
4674
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004675 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4676 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4677 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004678
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004679 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4680
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004681
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004682option tcp-smart-accept
4683no option tcp-smart-accept
4684 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4686 yes | yes | yes | no
4687 Arguments : none
4688
4689 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4690 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4691 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4692 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4693 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4694 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4695
4696 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4697 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4698 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4699 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4700
4701 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4702 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4703 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4704 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4705
4706 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4707 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4708 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4709
4710 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4711 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4712 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4713
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004714 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4715
4716
4717option tcp-smart-connect
4718no option tcp-smart-connect
4719 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 yes | no | yes | yes
4722 Arguments : none
4723
4724 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4725 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4726 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4727 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4728 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4729
4730 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4731 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4732 complex.
4733
4734 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4735 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4736 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4737
4738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4740
4741 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4742
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004743
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004744option tcpka
4745 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4751 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4752 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4753 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4754
4755 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4756 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4757 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4758 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4759
4760 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4761 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4762 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4763 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4764 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4765
4766 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4767
4768 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4769 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4770 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4771 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4772 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4773 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4774 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4775 backends.
4776
4777 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4778
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004779
4780option tcplog
4781 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4783 yes | yes | yes | yes
4784 Arguments : none
4785
4786 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4787 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4788 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4789 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4790 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4791 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4792 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4793 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4794
4795 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004797 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004798
4799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004800option transparent
4801no option transparent
4802 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004804 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004805 Arguments : none
4806
4807 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4808 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4809 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4810 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4811 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4812 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4813 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4814 appropriate server.
4815
4816 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4817 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4818
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004819 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004820 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004821
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004822
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004823persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004824persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004825 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | no | yes | yes
4828 Arguments :
4829 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004830 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4831 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004832
4833 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4834 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4835 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4836 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4837 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4838 forwarded to this server.
4839
4840 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4841 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4842 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004843 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004844 a single "listen" section.
4845
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004846 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4847 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4848 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4849
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004850 Example :
4851 listen tse-farm
4852 bind :3389
4853 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4854 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4855 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4856 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4857 persist rdp-cookie
4858 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004859 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004860 balance rdp-cookie
4861 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4862 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4863
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004864 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4865 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004866
4867
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004868rate-limit sessions <rate>
4869 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 yes | yes | yes | no
4872 Arguments :
4873 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4874 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4875
4876 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4877 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4878 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4879 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4880 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4881 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4882
4883 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4884 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4885 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4886 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4887
4888 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4889 listen smtp
4890 mode tcp
4891 bind :25
4892 rate-limit sessions 10
4893 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4894
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004895 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4896 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4897 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004898
4899 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4900
4901
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004902redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4903redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4904redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004905 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4907 no | yes | yes | yes
4908
4909 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004910 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004911
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004913 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004914 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
4915 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
4916 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004917
4918 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4919 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4920 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4921 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4922 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004923 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
4924 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
4925 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
4926 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004927
4928 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4929 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4930 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4931 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4932 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4933 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4934 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4935 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01004936 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
4937 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
4938 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004939
4940 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01004941 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
4942 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
4943 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
4944 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
4945 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
4946 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
4947 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
4948 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004949
4950 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4951 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4952
4953 - "drop-query"
4954 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4955 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4956 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4957 with a location-type redirect.
4958
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004959 - "append-slash"
4960 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4961 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4962 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4963 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4964
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004965 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4966 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4967 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4968 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4969 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4970 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4971 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4972
4973 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4974 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4975 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4976 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4977 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4978 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4979 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004980
4981 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4982 acl clear dst_port 80
4983 acl secure dst_port 8080
4984 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004985 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004986 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004987 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4988
4989 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004990 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4991 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4992 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004993 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004994
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004995 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4996 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4997 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4998
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004999 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005000 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005001
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005002 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5003 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5004 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005007
5008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005009redisp (deprecated)
5010redispatch (deprecated)
5011 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005014 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005015
5016 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5017 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5018 be able to access the service anymore.
5019
5020 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5021 redistribute them to a working server.
5022
5023 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5024 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5025 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005027 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5028 "option redispatch" instead.
5029
5030 See also : "option redispatch"
5031
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005032
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005033reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005034 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 no | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments :
5038 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5039 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005040 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005041
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005042 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5043 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5044
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005045 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5046 the last header of an HTTP request.
5047
5048 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5049 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5050 responses.
5051
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005052 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5053 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5054 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5055
5056 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5057 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005058
5059
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005060reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5061reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005062 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 no | yes | yes | yes
5065 Arguments :
5066 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5067 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5068 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5069 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5070 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5071 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5072 ignores case.
5073
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005074 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5075 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5076
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005077 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5078 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5079 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5080 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005081 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005082
5083 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5084 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5085
5086 Example :
5087 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5088 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5089 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5090
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005091 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5092 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005093
5094
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005095reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5096reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005097 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 no | yes | yes | yes
5100 Arguments :
5101 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5102 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5103 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5104 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5105 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5106 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005108 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5109 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5110
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005111 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5112 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5113 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5114 next servers.
5115
5116 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5117 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5118 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5119
5120 Example :
5121 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5122 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5123 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5124
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005125 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5126 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005127
5128
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005129reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5130reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005131 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 no | yes | yes | yes
5134 Arguments :
5135 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5136 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5137 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5138 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5139 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5140 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5141 case.
5142
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005143 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5144 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5145
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005146 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5147 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5148 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5149 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005150 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005151
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005152 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005153 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005154 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005155
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005156 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5157 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5158
5159 Example :
5160 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5161 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5162 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5163
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005164 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5165 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005166
5167
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005168reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5169reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005170 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5172 no | yes | yes | yes
5173 Arguments :
5174 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5175 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5176 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5177 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5178 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5179 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5180 case.
5181
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005182 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5183 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5184
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005185 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5186 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5187 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5188 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5189
5190 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5191 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5192
5193 Example :
5194 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5195 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5196 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5197 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5198
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005199 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5200 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005201
5202
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005203reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5204reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005205 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 no | yes | yes | yes
5208 Arguments :
5209 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5210 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5211 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5212 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5213 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5214 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5215
5216 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5217 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5218 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5219 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005220 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005221
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005222 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5223 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5224
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005225 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5226 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5227 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5228
5229 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5230 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5231 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5232 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5233 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5234
5235 Example :
5236 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005237 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005238 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5239 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5240
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005241 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5242 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005243
5244
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005245reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5246reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005247 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5249 no | yes | yes | yes
5250 Arguments :
5251 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5252 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5253 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5254 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5255 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5256 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5257 ignores case.
5258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005262 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5263 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005264 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5265 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5266 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005267 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5268 not set.
5269
5270 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5271 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5272 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5273 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5274 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5275
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005276 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005277 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5278 # block all others.
5279 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5280 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005282 # block bad guys
5283 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5284 reqitarpit . if badguys
5285
5286 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5287 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005288
5289
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005290retries <value>
5291 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | no | yes | yes
5294 Arguments :
5295 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5296 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5297 default value is 3.
5298
5299 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5300 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5301 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5302
5303 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5304 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5305
5306 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5307 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5308
5309 See also : "option redispatch"
5310
5311
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005312rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005313 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 no | yes | yes | yes
5316 Arguments :
5317 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5318 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005319 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005320
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005321 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5322 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5323
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005324 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5325 the last header of an HTTP response.
5326
5327 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5328 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5329 responses.
5330
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005331 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5332 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005333
5334
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005335rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5336rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5339 no | yes | yes | yes
5340 Arguments :
5341 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5342 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5343 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5344 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5345 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5346 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5347 ignores case.
5348
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005349 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5350 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5351
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005352 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5353 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005354 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005355 client.
5356
5357 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5358 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5359 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5360
5361 Example :
5362 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005363 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005364
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005365 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5366 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005367
5368
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005369rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5370rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005371 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 no | yes | yes | yes
5374 Arguments :
5375 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5376 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5377 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5378 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5379 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5380 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5381 ignores case.
5382
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005383 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5384 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005386 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5387 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5388 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5389 case-sensitive.
5390
5391 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005392 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5393 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5394 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005395
5396 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5397 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5398
5399 Example :
5400 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5401 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5402
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005403 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5404 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005405
5406
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005407rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5408rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005409 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5411 no | yes | yes | yes
5412 Arguments :
5413 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5414 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5415 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5416 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5417 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5418 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5419 ignores case.
5420
5421 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5422 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5423 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5424 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005425 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005426
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005427 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5428 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5429
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005430 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5431 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5432 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5433
5434 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5435 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5436 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5437 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5438 are not case-sensitive.
5439
5440 Example :
5441 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5442 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5443
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005444 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5445 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005446
5447
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005448server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005449 Declare a server in a backend
5450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5451 no | no | yes | yes
5452 Arguments :
5453 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005454 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005455 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005456
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005457 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5458 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5459 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5460 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005461 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5462 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5463 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5464 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5465 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005466 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5467 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5468 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5469 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5470 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5471 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5472 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005473 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5474 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5475 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5476 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005477
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005478 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005479 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5480 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5481 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5482 adding this value to the client's port.
5483
5484 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5485 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005486 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005487
5488 Examples :
5489 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5490 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005491 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005492 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5493 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5494 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005495
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005496 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5497 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005498
5499
5500source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005501source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005502source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005503 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5505 yes | no | yes | yes
5506 Arguments :
5507 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5508 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005509
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005510 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005511 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5512 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5513 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5514 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5515 supported prefixes are :
5516 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5517 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5518 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005519 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5520 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5521 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5522 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005523
5524 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5525 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005526 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5527 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5528 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005529
5530 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5531 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5532 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5533 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5534 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5535 <addr>.
5536
5537 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5538 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5539 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5540 port.
5541
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005542 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5543 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5544 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5545 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005546 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005547 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5548 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5549 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5550 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5551 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5552 HTTP header.
5553
5554 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5555 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005557 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5558 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5559 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5560 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5561 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5562 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5563 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5564
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005565 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5566 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5567 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5568 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5569 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5570 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5571
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005572 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5573 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5574 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5575 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5576
5577 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5578 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5579 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5580 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5581 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5582 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5583
5584 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5585 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5586 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5587 there are two methods :
5588
5589 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5590 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5591 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5592 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5593 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5594 of the client ranges may be used.
5595
5596 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5597 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5598 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5599 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5600 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5601 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5602 same session.
5603
5604 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5605 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5606 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5607 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5608 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5609 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5610
5611 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5612 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5613 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005614 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005615
5616 Examples :
5617 backend private
5618 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5619 source 192.168.1.200
5620
5621 backend transparent_ssl1
5622 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5623 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5624
5625 backend transparent_ssl2
5626 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5627 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5628 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5629
5630 backend transparent_ssl3
5631 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5632 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5633 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5634
5635 backend transparent_smtp
5636 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5637 # with Tproxy version 4.
5638 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5639
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005640 backend transparent_http
5641 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5642 # proxy.
5643 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005645 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005646 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005648
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005649srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5650 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | no | yes | yes
5653 Arguments :
5654 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5655 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5656 as explained at the top of this document.
5657
5658 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5659 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5660 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5661 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5662 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5663 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5664 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5665
5666 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5667 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5668 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5669 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5670 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005671 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005672 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005673 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005674
5675 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5676 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5677 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5678 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5679 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5680 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5681
5682 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5683 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5684
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005685 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5686 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005687
5688
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005689stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5690 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5692 no | no | yes | yes
5693
5694 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5695 matched.
5696
5697 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5698 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5699
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005700 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5701 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5702 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5703
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005704 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5705 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5706 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5707 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005708
5709 Example :
5710 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5711 backend stats_localhost
5712 stats enable
5713 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5714
5715 Example :
5716 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5717 backend stats_auth
5718 stats enable
5719 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5720 stats admin if TRUE
5721
5722 Example :
5723 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5724 userlist stats-auth
5725 group admin users admin
5726 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5727 group readonly users haproxy
5728 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5729
5730 backend stats_auth
5731 stats enable
5732 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5733 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5734 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5735 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5736
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005737 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5738 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5739 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005740
5741
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005742stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5743 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments :
5747 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5748
5749 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5750
5751 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5752 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5753 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5754 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5755 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5756 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5757
5758 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5759 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5760 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005761 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005762
5763 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5764 report using "stats scope".
5765
5766 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5767 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5768 unobvious parameters.
5769
5770 Example :
5771 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5772 backend public_www
5773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5774 stats enable
5775 stats hide-version
5776 stats scope .
5777 stats uri /admin?stats
5778 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5779 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5780 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5781
5782 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5783 backend private_monitoring
5784 stats enable
5785 stats uri /admin?stats
5786 stats refresh 5s
5787
5788 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5789
5790
5791stats enable
5792 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5794 yes | no | yes | yes
5795 Arguments : none
5796
5797 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5798 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5799 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5800 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5801 - stats auth : no authentication
5802 - stats scope : no restriction
5803
5804 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5805 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5806 unobvious parameters.
5807
5808 Example :
5809 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5810 backend public_www
5811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5812 stats enable
5813 stats hide-version
5814 stats scope .
5815 stats uri /admin?stats
5816 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5817 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5818 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5819
5820 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5821 backend private_monitoring
5822 stats enable
5823 stats uri /admin?stats
5824 stats refresh 5s
5825
5826 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5827
5828
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005829stats hide-version
5830 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005833 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005834
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005835 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5836 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5837 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5838 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5839 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5840 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005842 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5843 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5844 unobvious parameters.
5845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005846 Example :
5847 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5848 backend public_www
5849 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005850 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005851 stats hide-version
5852 stats scope .
5853 stats uri /admin?stats
5854 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5855 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5856 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005857
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005858 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5859 backend private_monitoring
5860 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005861 stats uri /admin?stats
5862 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005863
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005864 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005865
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005866
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005867stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5868 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5869 Access control for statistics
5870
5871 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 no | no | yes | yes
5873
5874 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5875 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5876 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5877 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5878 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5879 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5880
5881 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5882 instance.
5883
5884 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5885 about ACL usage.
5886
5887
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005888stats realm <realm>
5889 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5891 yes | no | yes | yes
5892 Arguments :
5893 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5894 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5895 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5896
5897 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5898 using a backslash ('\').
5899
5900 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5901 only related to authentication.
5902
5903 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5904 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5905 unobvious parameters.
5906
5907 Example :
5908 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5909 backend public_www
5910 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5911 stats enable
5912 stats hide-version
5913 stats scope .
5914 stats uri /admin?stats
5915 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5916 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5917 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5918
5919 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5920 backend private_monitoring
5921 stats enable
5922 stats uri /admin?stats
5923 stats refresh 5s
5924
5925 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5926
5927
5928stats refresh <delay>
5929 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5931 yes | no | yes | yes
5932 Arguments :
5933 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5934 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5935 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5936 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5937 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5938 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5939
5940 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5941 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5942 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5943 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5944
5945 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5946 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5947 unobvious parameters.
5948
5949 Example :
5950 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5951 backend public_www
5952 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5953 stats enable
5954 stats hide-version
5955 stats scope .
5956 stats uri /admin?stats
5957 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5958 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5959 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5960
5961 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5962 backend private_monitoring
5963 stats enable
5964 stats uri /admin?stats
5965 stats refresh 5s
5966
5967 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5968
5969
5970stats scope { <name> | "." }
5971 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 yes | no | yes | yes
5974 Arguments :
5975 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5976 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5977 section in which the statement appears.
5978
5979 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5980 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5981 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5982 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5983 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5984 exists.
5985
5986 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5987 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5988 unobvious parameters.
5989
5990 Example :
5991 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5992 backend public_www
5993 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5994 stats enable
5995 stats hide-version
5996 stats scope .
5997 stats uri /admin?stats
5998 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5999 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6000 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6001
6002 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6003 backend private_monitoring
6004 stats enable
6005 stats uri /admin?stats
6006 stats refresh 5s
6007
6008 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6009
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006010
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006011stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006012 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 yes | no | yes | yes
6015
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006016 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006017 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6018
6019 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6020 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6021
6022 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6023 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006024 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006025
6026 Example :
6027 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6028 backend private_monitoring
6029 stats enable
6030 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6031 stats uri /admin?stats
6032 stats refresh 5s
6033
6034 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6035 global section.
6036
6037
6038stats show-legends
6039 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
6040 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6041 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6042 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6043 - IP (socket, server)
6044 - cookie (backend, server)
6045
6046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006048 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006049
6050 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6051
6052
6053stats show-node [ <name> ]
6054 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6056 yes | no | yes | yes
6057 Arguments:
6058 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6059 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6060
6061 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6062 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006063 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006064
6065 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6066 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6067 unobvious parameters.
6068
6069 Example:
6070 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6071 backend private_monitoring
6072 stats enable
6073 stats show-node Europe-1
6074 stats uri /admin?stats
6075 stats refresh 5s
6076
6077 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6078 section.
6079
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006080
6081stats uri <prefix>
6082 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | no | yes | yes
6085 Arguments :
6086 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6087 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6088 query string.
6089
6090 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6091 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6092 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6093 possible to reach it in the application.
6094
6095 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006096 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006097 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6098 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6099 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6100 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6101
6102 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6103 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6104 an address or a port to statistics only.
6105
6106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6108 unobvious parameters.
6109
6110 Example :
6111 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6112 backend public_www
6113 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6114 stats enable
6115 stats hide-version
6116 stats scope .
6117 stats uri /admin?stats
6118 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6119 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6120 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6121
6122 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6123 backend private_monitoring
6124 stats enable
6125 stats uri /admin?stats
6126 stats refresh 5s
6127
6128 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6129
6130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006131stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6132 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006134 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006135
6136 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006137 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006138 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6139 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6140 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6141
6142 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6143 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6144 the "stick-table" statement.
6145
6146 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6147 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6148 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6149 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6150 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6151
6152 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6153 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6154 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6155 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6156 transformation rules.
6157
6158 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6159 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6160 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6161 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6162 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6163 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6164 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6165
6166 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6167 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6168 ACL based conditions.
6169
6170 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6171 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6172 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6173 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6174
6175 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6176 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6177 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6178 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6179
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006180 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6181 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6182 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6183
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006184 Example :
6185 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6186 # last 30 minutes
6187 backend pop
6188 mode tcp
6189 balance roundrobin
6190 stick store-request src
6191 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6192 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6193 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6194
6195 backend smtp
6196 mode tcp
6197 balance roundrobin
6198 stick match src table pop
6199 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6200 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6201
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006202 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6203 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006204
6205
6206stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6207 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 no | no | yes | yes
6210
6211 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6212 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6213 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6214 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6215
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006216 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6217 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6218 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6219
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006220 Examples :
6221 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006222 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006223
6224 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6225 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6226 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6227
6228
6229 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6230 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6231 backend http
6232 mode http
6233 balance roundrobin
6234 stick on src table https
6235 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6236 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6237 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6238
6239 backend https
6240 mode tcp
6241 balance roundrobin
6242 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6243 stick on src
6244 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6245 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6246
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006247 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006248
6249
6250stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6251 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 no | no | yes | yes
6254
6255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006256 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006257 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6258 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6259 server is selected.
6260
6261 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6262 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6263 the "stick-table" statement.
6264
6265 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6266 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6267 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6268 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6269 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6270 address.
6271
6272 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6273 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6274 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6275 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6276 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6277 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6278 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6279 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6280 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6281 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6282
6283 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6284 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6285 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6286 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6287 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6288 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6289 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6290
6291 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6292 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6293 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6294 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6295
6296 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6297 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6298 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6299 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6300 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6301 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006302 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6303 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6304 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6305 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6306 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6307 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006308
6309 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6310 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6311 the request.
6312
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006313 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6314 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6315 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6316
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006317 Example :
6318 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6319 # last 30 minutes
6320 backend pop
6321 mode tcp
6322 balance roundrobin
6323 stick store-request src
6324 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6325 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6326 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6327
6328 backend smtp
6329 mode tcp
6330 balance roundrobin
6331 stick match src table pop
6332 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6333 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6334
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006335 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6336 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006337
6338
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006339stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006340 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6341 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006342 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006344 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006345
6346 Arguments :
6347 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6348 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6349 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6350 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6351
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006352 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6353 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6354 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6355 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6356
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006357 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6358 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6359 instance.
6360
6361 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6362 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6363 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6364 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6365 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6366 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006367 to 32 characters.
6368
6369 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6370 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6371 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6372 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6373 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6374 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006375
6376 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006377 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6378 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006379 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6380 increase.
6381
6382 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006383 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6384 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6385 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006386
6387 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6388 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6389 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6390 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6391 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6392 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6393 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6394 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6395 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6396 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6397 parameter (see below).
6398
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006399 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6400 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6401 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6402 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6403 soft restart.
6404
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006405 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6406
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006407 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6408 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6409 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6410 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6411 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006412 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006413 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6414 if not expiration delay is specified.
6415
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006416 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6417 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6418 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6419 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006420 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6421 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6422 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6423 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6424 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6425 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6426 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6427 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6428 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6429 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6430 types and their arguments.
6431
6432 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6433 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6434 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6435 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6436
6437 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6438 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6439 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6440 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6441
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006442 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6443 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6444 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6445 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6446 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6447 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6448
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006449 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6450 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6451 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6452 they were received.
6453
6454 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6455 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6456 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6457 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6458 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6459
6460 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6461 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6462 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6463 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6464 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6465
6466 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6467 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6468 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6469
6470 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6473 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6474 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6475
6476 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6477 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6478 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6479 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6480 the client side.
6481
6482 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6483 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6484 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6485 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6486 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6487 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6488 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6489
6490 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6491 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6492 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6493 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6494 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6495 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6496 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6497
6498 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6499 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6500 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6501 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6502 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6503 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6504
6505 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6506 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6507 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6508 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6509
6510 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6511 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6512 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6513 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6514 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6515 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6516 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6517 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6518 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6519 recommended for better fairness.
6520
6521 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6522 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6523 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6524 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6525
6526 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6527 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6528 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6529 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6530 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6531 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6532 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6533 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6534 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6535 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006536
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006537 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6538 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006539 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6540 reference it.
6541
6542 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6543 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6544 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6545 as an exclusive stickiness.
6546
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006547 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6548 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6549 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6550 something that can be ignored.
6551
6552 Example:
6553 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6554 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6555 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6556 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6557
6558 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006559 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006560
6561
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006562stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6563 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6565 no | no | yes | yes
6566
6567 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006568 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006569 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6570 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6571 server is selected.
6572
6573 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6574 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6575 the "stick-table" statement.
6576
6577 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6578 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6579 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6580 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6581
6582 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6583 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6584 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6585 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6586 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6587 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006588 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006589 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6590 rules.
6591
6592 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6593 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6594 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6595 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6596 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6597 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6598 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6599
6600 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6601 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6602 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6603 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6604
6605 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6606 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6607 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6608 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6609 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6610 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006611 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6612 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6613 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6614 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6615 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6616 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6617 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6618 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6619 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006620
6621 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6622
6623 Example :
6624 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6625 backend https
6626 mode tcp
6627 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006628 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006629 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006631 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6632 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6633
6634 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6635 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6636 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6637
6638 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6639 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006640
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006641 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6642 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6643 # at offset 44.
6644
6645 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6646 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6647
6648 # Learn on response if server hello.
6649 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006650
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006651 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6652 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6653
6654 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6655 extraction.
6656
6657
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006658tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6659 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006662 Arguments :
6663 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006664 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6665 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006666
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006667 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006668
6669 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6670 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006671 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6672 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6673 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6674 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6675 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6676 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006678 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6679 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6680 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6681 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006682
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006683 Three types of actions are supported :
6684 - accept :
6685 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6686 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6687 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006689 - reject :
6690 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6691 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6692 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6693 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6694 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6695 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6696 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6697 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6698 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6699 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6700 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6701 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006702
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006703 - expect-proxy layer4 :
6704 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
6705 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
6706 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
6707 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
6708 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
6709 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
6710 hosts.
6711
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006712 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006713 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6714 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6715 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006716 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6717 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006718 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006719 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
6720 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
6721 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
6722 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
6723 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006724
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006725 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006726 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006727 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006728 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
6729 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
6730 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
6731 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006732
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006733 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6734 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6735 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6736 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006738 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6739 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6740 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6741 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6742 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006743 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
6744 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
6745 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
6746 layer7 information is extracted.
6747
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006748 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6749 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6750 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6751 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6752 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006753
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006754 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6755 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6756 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006758 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6759 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6760 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006761
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006762 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006763 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006764 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006766 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6767 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6768 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006769
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006770 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006771 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6772 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006773
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02006774 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
6775
6776 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
6777
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006778 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006780 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006781
6782
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006783tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6784 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006786 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006787 Arguments :
6788 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006789 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6790 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006791 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006792
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006793 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006794
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006795 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6796 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6797 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6798 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6799 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006801 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6802 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6803 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6804 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6805 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6806 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6807 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6808 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6809 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006811 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6812 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6813 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6814 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006816 Three types of actions are supported :
6817 - accept :
6818 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006819 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006821 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6822 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006824 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6825 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6826 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006827 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. This makes a subtle
6828 difference because tracking rules in "frontend" and "listen" section last for
6829 all the session, as opposed to the backend rules. The difference appears when
6830 some layer 7 information is tracked. While there is nothing mandatory about
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006831 it, it is recommended to use the track-sc0 pointer to track per-frontend
6832 counters and track-sc1 to track per-backend counters, but this is just a
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02006833 guideline and all counters may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006835 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006836 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6837 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006838
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006839 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006840 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6841 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6842 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6843 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6844 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006845
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006846 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
6847 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
6848 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
6849 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
6850
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006851 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006852 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6853 # and reject everything else.
6854 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6855 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006856 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006857 tcp-request content reject
6858
6859 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006860 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6861 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6862 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006863 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006864
6865 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6866 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6867 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006868 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006869 tcp-request content reject
6870
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006871 Example:
6872 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
6873 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006874 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006875
6876 Example:
6877 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
6878 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006879 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01006880
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006881 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6882 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6883
6884 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006885 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006886 # protecting all our sites
6887 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006888 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
6889 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006890 ...
6891 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6892
6893 backend http_dynamic
6894 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006895 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006896 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006897 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6898 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
6899 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006900 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006902 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006903
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006904 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006905
6906
6907tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6908 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006910 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006911 Arguments :
6912 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6913 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6914 as explained at the top of this document.
6915
6916 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6917 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6918 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6919 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6920 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6921
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006922 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6923 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6924 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6925 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6926
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006927 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6928 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006929 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006930 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006931 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6932 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6933 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6934 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006935
6936 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6937 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6938 it pass through unaffected.
6939
6940 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6941 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6942 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006943 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006944 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6945 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006946 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6947 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6948 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006949
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006950 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006951 "timeout client".
6952
6953
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006954tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6955 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 no | no | yes | yes
6958 Arguments :
6959 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006960 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006961
6962 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6963
6964 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6965 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6966 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006967 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
6968 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006969
6970 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6971
6972 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6973 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6974 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6975 inserted.
6976
6977 Two types of actions are supported :
6978 - accept :
6979 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6980 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6981 the rules evaluation.
6982
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02006983 - close :
6984 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
6985 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
6986 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
6987 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
6988 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
6989 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
6990 connections which take signifiant resources on servers with certain
6991 protocols.
6992
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006993 - reject :
6994 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6995 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006996 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006997
6998 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6999 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7000 for changing the default action to a reject.
7001
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007002 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7003 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7004 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7005 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007006 period.
7007
7008 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7009
7010 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7011
7012
7013tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7014 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 no | no | yes | yes
7017 Arguments :
7018 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7019 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7020 as explained at the top of this document.
7021
7022 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7023
7024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007025timeout check <timeout>
7026 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7027 established.
7028
7029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7030 yes | no | yes | yes
7031 Arguments:
7032 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7033 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7034 as explained at the top of this document.
7035
7036 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7037 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7038 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7039 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007040 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7041 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7042 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007043
7044 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7045 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7046
7047 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7048 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007049 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007050
7051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7053 forget about it.
7054
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007055 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7056 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007057
7058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007059timeout client <timeout>
7060timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7061 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7063 yes | yes | yes | no
7064 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007065 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7067 as explained at the top of this document.
7068
7069 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7070 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7071 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7072 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7073 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7074 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7075 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7076 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007077 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007078 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007079 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7080 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7081 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007082
7083 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7084 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7085 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7086 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7087 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7088 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7089
7090 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7091 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7092 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7093
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007094 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007095
7096
7097timeout connect <timeout>
7098timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7099 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7101 yes | no | yes | yes
7102 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007103 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007104 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7105 as explained at the top of this document.
7106
7107 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007108 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007109 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007110 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007111 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7112 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007113
7114 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7120
7121 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7122 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7123 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7124
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007125 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7126 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007127
7128
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007129timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7130 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 yes | yes | yes | yes
7133 Arguments :
7134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7136 as explained at the top of this document.
7137
7138 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7139 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7140 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7141 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7142 once the request has started to present itself.
7143
7144 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7145 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7146 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7147 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7148 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7149
7150 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7151 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7152 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7153 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7154
7155 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7156 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7157 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7158 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7159 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007160 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007161
7162 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7163 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7164 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7165 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7166
7167 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7168
7169
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007170timeout http-request <timeout>
7171 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007173 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007174 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007175 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007176 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7177 as explained at the top of this document.
7178
7179 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7180 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7181 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7182 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7183 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7184 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7185 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7186 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7187
7188 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7189 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007190 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7191 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007192
7193 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7194 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7195 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7196 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7197 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7198
7199 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007200 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7201 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7202 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007203
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007204 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007205
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007206
7207timeout queue <timeout>
7208 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 yes | no | yes | yes
7211 Arguments :
7212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7214 as explained at the top of this document.
7215
7216 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7217 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7218 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7219 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7220 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7221
7222 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7223 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7224 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7225 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7226
7227 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7228
7229
7230timeout server <timeout>
7231timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7232 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | no | yes | yes
7235 Arguments :
7236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7238 as explained at the top of this document.
7239
7240 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7241 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7242 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7243 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7244 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7245 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7246 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7247
7248 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7249 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7250 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7251 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7252 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007253 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007254 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007255 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7256 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7257 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7258 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007259
7260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7264 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7266
7267 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7268 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7269 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7270
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007271 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007272
7273
7274timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007275 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 yes | yes | yes | yes
7278 Arguments :
7279 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7281 as explained at the top of this document.
7282
7283 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7284 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7285 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7286
7287 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7288 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7289 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7290 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007291 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007292
7293 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7294
7295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007296timeout tunnel <timeout>
7297 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 yes | no | yes | yes
7300 Arguments :
7301 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7303 as explained at the top of this document.
7304
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007305 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007306 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7307 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7308 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7309 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7310 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7311 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7312 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7313 specified.
7314
7315 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7316 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7317 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7318 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7319 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7320
7321 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7322 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7323 forget about it.
7324
7325 Example :
7326 defaults http
7327 option http-server-close
7328 timeout connect 5s
7329 timeout client 30s
7330 timeout client 30s
7331 timeout server 30s
7332 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7333
7334 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7335
7336
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007337transparent (deprecated)
7338 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007340 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007341 Arguments : none
7342
7343 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7344 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7345 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7346 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7347 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7348 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7349 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7350 appropriate server.
7351
7352 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7353
7354 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7355 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7356
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007357 See also: "option transparent"
7358
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007359unique-id-format <string>
7360 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7362 yes | yes | yes | no
7363 Arguments :
7364 <string> is a log-format string.
7365
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007366 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7367 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7368 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7369 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007370
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007371 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7372 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7373 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7374 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7375 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7376 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7377 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7378 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007379
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007380 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7381 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007382
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007383 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007384
7385 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7386
7387 will generate:
7388
7389 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7390
7391 See also: "unique-id-header"
7392
7393unique-id-header <name>
7394 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7396 yes | yes | yes | no
7397 Arguments :
7398 <name> is the name of the header.
7399
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007400 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7401 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007402
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007403 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007404
7405 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
7406 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7407
7408 will generate:
7409
7410 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7411
7412 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007413
7414use_backend <backend> if <condition>
7415use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007416 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 no | yes | yes | no
7419 Arguments :
7420 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
7421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007422 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007423
7424 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7425 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7426 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007427 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7428 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7429 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7430 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007431
7432 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7433 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7434 assign the backend.
7435
7436 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7437 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7438 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7439 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7440 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7441 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7442
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007443 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007444 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007445 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7446 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7447 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7448
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007449 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007450
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007451
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007452use-server <server> if <condition>
7453use-server <server> unless <condition>
7454 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7456 no | no | yes | yes
7457 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007458 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007459
7460 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7461
7462 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7463 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7464 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7465
7466 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7467 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7468 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7469 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7470 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7471 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7472 matches will assign the server.
7473
7474 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7475 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7476 with the next rules until one matches.
7477
7478 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7479 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7480 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7481 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7482
7483 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7484 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7485 stripped.
7486
7487 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7488 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7489 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7490 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7491
7492 Example :
7493 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7494 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7495 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7496 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7497 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7498 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7499 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7500 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7501 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7502
7503 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
7504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007505
75065. Bind and Server options
7507--------------------------
7508
7509The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7510depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7511settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7512written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7513described in this section.
7514
7515
75165.1. Bind options
7517-----------------
7518
7519The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7520as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7521no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7522parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7523while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7524provided immediately after the setting name.
7525
7526The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7527
7528accept-proxy
7529 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7530 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7531 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7532 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7533 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7534 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7535 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7536 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7537 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007538 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7539 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007540
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007541alpn <protocols>
7542 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7543 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7544 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7545 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7546 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7547 initial NPN extension.
7548
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007549backlog <backlog>
7550 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7551 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7552
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007553ecdhe <named curve>
7554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007555 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7556 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007557
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007558ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7560 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7561 client's certificate.
7562
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007563ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7565 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7566 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7567 error is ignored.
7568
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007569ciphers <ciphers>
7570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7571 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
7572 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
7573 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7574 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7575
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007576crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7578 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7579 to verify client's certificate.
7580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007581crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7583 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7584 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7585 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7586 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7587 file.
7588
7589 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7590 are loaded.
7591
7592 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7593 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7594 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7595 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7596 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7597 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7598 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7599 www.sub.example.org).
7600
7601 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7602 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7603 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7604 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7605 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7606
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007607 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007608
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007609 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7610 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
7611 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires a intermediate CA (for
7612 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7613 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7614 clients).
7615
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007616crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7618 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
7619 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an error
7620 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007621
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007622crt-list <file>
7623 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007624 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7625 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007626
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007627 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007628
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007629 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7630 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7631 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7632 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7633 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7634 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7635 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7636 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007637
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007638defer-accept
7639 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7640 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7641 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7642 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7643 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7644 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7645 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7646 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7647 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7648 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7649 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7650
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007651force-sslv3
7652 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7653 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7654 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7655
7656force-tlsv10
7657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7658 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7659
7660force-tlsv11
7661 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7662 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7663
7664force-tlsv12
7665 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
7666 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007668gid <gid>
7669 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7670 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7671 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7672 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7673 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7674
7675group <group>
7676 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7677 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7678 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7679 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7680 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7681
7682id <id>
7683 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
7684 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
7685 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
7686 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
7687
7688interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01007689 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
7690 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
7691 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
7692 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
7693 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
7694 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
7695 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007696
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02007697level <level>
7698 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
7699 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
7700 sockets. <level> can be one of :
7701 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
7702 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
7703 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
7704 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
7705 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
7706 counters).
7707 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
7708 all counters).
7709
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007710maxconn <maxconn>
7711 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
7712 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
7713 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
7714 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
7715 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
7716 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
7717 eat all memory.
7718
7719mode <mode>
7720 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
7721 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
7722 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
7723 UNIX sockets.
7724
7725mss <maxseg>
7726 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
7727 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
7728 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
7729 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
7730 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
7731 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
7732 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
7733 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
7734 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
7735 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
7736 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
7737
7738name <name>
7739 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7740 page.
7741
7742nice <nice>
7743 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7744 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7745 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7746 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7747 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7748 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7749 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7750 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7751 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7752 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7753 one for an RDP socket.
7754
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007755no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7757 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7758 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007759 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7760 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007761
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007762no-tls-tickets
7763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7764 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7765 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7766 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7767
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007768no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007770 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7771 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7772 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7773 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007774
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007775no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007777 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7778 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7779 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7780 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007781
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007782no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007784 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7785 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7786 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7787 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007788
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007789npn <protocols>
7790 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7791 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7792 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7793 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007794 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
7795 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007797ssl
7798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7799 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7800 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7801 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7802 to deciphered contents.
7803
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01007804strict-sni
7805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
7806 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
7807 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
7808 See the "crt" option for more information.
7809
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007810tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01007811 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007812 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7813 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7814 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7815 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7816 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7817 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7818 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02007819 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
7820 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
7821 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007822
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007823transparent
7824 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7825 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7826 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7827 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7828 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7829 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7830 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7831 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7832 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7833 so check for support with your vendor.
7834
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007835v4v6
7836 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7837 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
7838 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
7839 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
7840 sockets, and is overriden by the "v6only" option.
7841
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007842v6only
7843 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
7844 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
7845 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01007846 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
7847 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01007848
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007849uid <uid>
7850 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7851 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7852 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7853 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7854 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7855
7856user <user>
7857 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7858 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7859 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7860 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7861 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7862
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007863verify [none|optional|required]
7864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7865 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7866 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7867 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7868 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007869 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7870 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7871 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7872 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020078745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007875------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007877The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7878which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7879arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7880settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7881after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7882Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7883address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007885 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007886 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007887
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007888The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007889
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007890addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007891 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7892 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7893 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7894 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7895 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007897 Supported in default-server: No
7898
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007899agent-check
7900 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
7901 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
7902 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
7903 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
7904
7905 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
7906 e.g. "75%"
7907
7908 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
7909 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
7910
7911 * The string "drain".
7912
7913 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
7914 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
7915 persistence.
7916
7917 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
7918
7919 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
7920
7921 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
7922
7923 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7924
7925 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
7926
7927 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
7928
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09007929 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
7930 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
7931 parameter.
7932
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09007933 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
7934 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
7935
7936 Supported in default-server: No
7937
7938agent-inter <delay>
7939 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
7940 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7941
7942 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
7943 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
7944 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
7945 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7946 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
7947 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
7948 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
7949 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
7950 of backends use the same servers.
7951
7952 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
7953
7954 Supported in default-server: Yes
7955
7956agent-port <port>
7957 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
7958
7959 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
7960
7961 Supported in default-server: Yes
7962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007963backup
7964 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7965 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7966 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7967 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7968 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7969 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007971 Supported in default-server: No
7972
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007973ca-file <cafile>
7974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7975 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7976 server's certificate.
7977
7978 Supported in default-server: No
7979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007980check
7981 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007982 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7983 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7984 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7985 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7986 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7987 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7988 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007989 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7990 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7991 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007993 Supported in default-server: No
7994
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007995check-send-proxy
7996 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7997 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7998 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7999 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8000 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8001 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8002 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8003
8004 Supported in default-server: No
8005
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008006check-ssl
8007 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8008 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8009 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8010 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
8011 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
8012 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8013 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8014 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8015 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8016
8017 Supported in default-server: No
8018
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008019ciphers <ciphers>
8020 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
8021 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
8022 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8023 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8024 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8025 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8026 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8027 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8028
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008029 Supported in default-server: No
8030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008031cookie <value>
8032 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8033 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8034 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8035 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8036 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8037 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8038 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008040 Supported in default-server: No
8041
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008042crl-file <crlfile>
8043 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8044 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8045 to verify server's certificate.
8046
8047 Supported in default-server: No
8048
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008049crt <cert>
8050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8051 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8052 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8053 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8054 certificate request.
8055
8056 Supported in default-server: No
8057
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008058disabled
8059 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8060 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8061 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8062 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8063 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8064
8065 Supported in default-server: No
8066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008067error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008068 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8069 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8070 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008071
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008072 Supported in default-server: Yes
8073
8074 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008076fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008077 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8078 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8079 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008081 Supported in default-server: Yes
8082
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008083force-sslv3
8084 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8085 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8086 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8087
8088 Supported in default-server: No
8089
8090force-tlsv10
8091 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8092 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8093
8094 Supported in default-server: No
8095
8096force-tlsv11
8097 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8098 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8099
8100 Supported in default-server: No
8101
8102force-tlsv12
8103 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8104 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8105
8106 Supported in default-server: No
8107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008108id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008109 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8110 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8111 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008113 Supported in default-server: No
8114
8115inter <delay>
8116fastinter <delay>
8117downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008118 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8119 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8120 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8121 between checks depending on the server state :
8122
8123 Server state | Interval used
8124 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8125 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8126 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8127 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8128 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8129 or yet unchecked. |
8130 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8131 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8132 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008134 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8135 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8136 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8137 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008138 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8139 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8140 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8141 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8142 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008144 Supported in default-server: Yes
8145
8146maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008147 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8148 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8149 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8150 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8151 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8152 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8153 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8154 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008156 Supported in default-server: Yes
8157
8158maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008159 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8160 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8161 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8162 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8163 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8164 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8165 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008167 Supported in default-server: Yes
8168
8169minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008170 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8171 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8172 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8173 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8174 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8175 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008176 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008177 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008179 Supported in default-server: Yes
8180
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008181no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008182 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8183 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008184 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008185
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008186 Supported in default-server: No
8187
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008188no-tls-tickets
8189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8190 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8191 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8192 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8193
8194 Supported in default-server: No
8195
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008196no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008197 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008198 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8199 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008200 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8201 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008202
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008203 Supported in default-server: No
8204
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008205no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008206 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008207 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8208 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008209 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8210 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008211
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008212 Supported in default-server: No
8213
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008214no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008215 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008216 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8217 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008218 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8219 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008220
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008221 Supported in default-server: No
8222
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008223non-stick
8224 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8225 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8226 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8227
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008228 Supported in default-server: No
8229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008230observe <mode>
8231 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8232 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8233 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8234 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8235 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8236 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008237 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008239 Supported in default-server: No
8240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008241 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008243on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008244 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8245 Currently, four modes are available:
8246 - fastinter: force fastinter
8247 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8248 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8249 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8250 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008252 Supported in default-server: Yes
8253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008254 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8255
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008256on-marked-down <action>
8257 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8258 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008259 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8260 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8261 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8262 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8263 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8264 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8265 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8266 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008267
8268 Actions are disabled by default
8269
8270 Supported in default-server: Yes
8271
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008272on-marked-up <action>
8273 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8274 Currently one action is available:
8275 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8276 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8277 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8278 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8279 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8280 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8281 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8282 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8283
8284 Actions are disabled by default
8285
8286 Supported in default-server: Yes
8287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008288port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008289 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8290 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8291 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8292 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8293 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8294 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008296 Supported in default-server: Yes
8297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008298redir <prefix>
8299 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8300 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8301 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8302 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8303 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8304 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8305 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8306 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008307 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008308 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8309 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8310 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8311 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8312 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8313
8314 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008316 Supported in default-server: No
8317
8318rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8320 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8321 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008323 Supported in default-server: Yes
8324
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008325send-proxy
8326 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8327 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8328 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8329 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8330 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8331 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8332 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8333 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8334 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008335 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8336 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8337 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8338 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8339 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008340
8341 Supported in default-server: No
8342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008343slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008344 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8345 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8346 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8347 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8348 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8349 parameters :
8350
8351 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8352 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8353
8354 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8355 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8356 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8357 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8358
8359 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8360 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8361 seen as failed.
8362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008363 Supported in default-server: Yes
8364
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008365source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008366source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008367source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008368 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8369 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8370 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8371 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8372
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008373 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8374 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8375 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8376 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8377 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8378 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8379 server.
8380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008381 Supported in default-server: No
8382
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008383ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008384 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8385 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8386 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8387 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8388 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8389 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
8390 See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008391
8392 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008394track [<proxy>/]<server>
8395 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8396 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8397 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8398 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8399 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008401 Supported in default-server: No
8402
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008403verify [none|required]
8404 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8405 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
8406 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
8407 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008408 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8409 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8410 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008411
8412 Supported in default-server: No
8413
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008414verifyhost <hostname>
8415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8416 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8417 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8418 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8419 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8420 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8421
8422 Supported in default-server: No
8423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008424weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008425 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8426 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8427 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008428 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8429 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8430 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8431 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8432 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8433 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008435 Supported in default-server: Yes
8436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008437
84386. HTTP header manipulation
8439---------------------------
8440
8441In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8442response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8443request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8444which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
8445against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
8446to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
8447passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
8448headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
8449never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
8450
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008451There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
8452(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
8453rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
8454messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
8455in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008456happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008457add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
8458normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
8459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8461in section 4.2 :
8462
8463 - reqadd <string>
8464 - reqallow <search>
8465 - reqiallow <search>
8466 - reqdel <search>
8467 - reqidel <search>
8468 - reqdeny <search>
8469 - reqideny <search>
8470 - reqpass <search>
8471 - reqipass <search>
8472 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8473 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8474 - reqtarpit <search>
8475 - reqitarpit <search>
8476 - rspadd <string>
8477 - rspdel <search>
8478 - rspidel <search>
8479 - rspdeny <search>
8480 - rspideny <search>
8481 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8482 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8483
8484With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8485is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8486parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8487prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8488Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8489
8490 \t for a tab
8491 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8492 \n for a new line (LF)
8493 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8494 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8495 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8496 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8497 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8498
8499The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8500portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8501above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8502regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
85039 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8504is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8505
8506The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8507after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8508
8509Notes related to these keywords :
8510---------------------------------
8511 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8512 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8513 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8514
8515 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8516 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8517 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8518
8519 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8520 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8521 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8522 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8523 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8524
8525 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8526 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8527 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8528 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8529 useless headers before adding new ones.
8530
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008531 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008532 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8533
8534 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8535 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8536 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8537
8538 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8539 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008540 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008541
8542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020085437. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8544----------------------------------
8545
8546Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8547client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8548The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8549these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8550but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8551data called patterns.
8552
8553
85547.1. ACL basics
8555---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008556
8557The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8558content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8559from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8560simple :
8561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008562 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008563 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008564 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8565 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008567The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8568adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008569
8570In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008572 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008573
8574This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8575Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8576and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008577an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8578conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8579as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8580are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008581
8582ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8583'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8584which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8585
8586There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8587performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008589The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8590specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8591this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008592methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8593ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008594
8595Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8596 - boolean
8597 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8598 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8599 - string
8600 - data block
8601
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008602Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8603converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8604would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8605The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8606which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008608The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8609 - boolean
8610 - integer or integer range
8611 - IP address / network
8612 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8613 - regular expression
8614 - hex block
8615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008616The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8617
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008618 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8619 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008620 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008621 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008623The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8624read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8625if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8626lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8627will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8628beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8629a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8630lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8631exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8632
8633Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8634loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8635
8636 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8637
8638In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8639the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8640case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8641as well.
8642
8643The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8644sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8645do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8646methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8647is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8648obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8649followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8650default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8651that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8652string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8653
8654There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8655sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8656be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008657
8658 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8659 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008660 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8661 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8662 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8663 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008664
8665 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
8666 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008667 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008668
8669 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008670 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008671
8672 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008673 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008674
8675 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
8676 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
8677
8678 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
8679 binary or string samples.
8680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008681 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
8682 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008684 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
8685 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
8686 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008688 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
8689 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008691 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
8692 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008694 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
8695 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008697 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
8698 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008699 This may be used with binary or string samples.
8700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008701 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
8702 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
8703 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008704
8705For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
8706request, it is possible to do :
8707
8708 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
8709
8710In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
8711buffer, one would use the following acl :
8712
8713 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
8714
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008715On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
8716possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
8717
8718 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
8719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008720All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
8721criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
8722method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
8723to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
8724criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
8725the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008727If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
8728the mathing method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method. For
8729example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008731 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
8732 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
8733 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
8734 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008735
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008736
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008737The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008738and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
8739combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
8740the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008742 +-------------------------------------------------+
8743 | Input sample type |
8744 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8745 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
8746 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8747 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
8748 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008749 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008750 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008751 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008752 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008753 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008754 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008755 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008756 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008757 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008758 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008759 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008760 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008761 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008762 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008763 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008764 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008765 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008766 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008767 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008768 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01008769 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008770 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
8771 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
8772 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008773
8774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020087757.1.1. Matching booleans
8776------------------------
8777
8778In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
8779Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
8780When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
8781that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
8782
8783Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
8784return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
8785"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
8786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020087887.1.2. Matching integers
8789------------------------
8790
8791Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
8792enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
8793to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
8794
8795Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
8796matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
8797lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008798
8799For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
8800unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
8801representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
8802
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008803As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
8804two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
8805instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
8806ranges and operators.
8807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008808For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008809operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
8810Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
8811of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008813Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008814
8815 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
8816 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
8817 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
8818 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
8819 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
8820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008821For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008822
8823 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
8824
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008825This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
8826
8827 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
8828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088307.1.3. Matching strings
8831-----------------------
8832
8833String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
8834different forms :
8835
8836 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
8837 patterns ;
8838
8839 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
8840 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
8841
8842 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
8843 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8844
8845 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
8846 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
8847
8848 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8849 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
8850 matches.
8851
8852 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
8853 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
8854 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008855
8856String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
8857exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
8858characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
8859string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
8860to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008861before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008862
8863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088647.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
8865---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008866
8867Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
8868they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
8869possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
8870passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
8871the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008872the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
8873match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008874
8875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088767.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
8877-------------------------------------
8878
8879It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
8880not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
8881a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
8882to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
8883digits may be used upper or lower case.
8884
8885Example :
8886 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
8887 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
8888
8889
88907.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
8891---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008892
8893IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
8894netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
8895within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008896host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008897difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
8898at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
8899does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
8900parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008901
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008902IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
8903Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
8904trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
8905IPv6 patterns.
8906
8907HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
8908following situations :
8909 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
8910 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
8911 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
8912 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
8913 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
8914 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
8915 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
8916 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
8917 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
8918 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
8919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008920
89217.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
8922----------------------------------
8923
8924Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8925combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
8926
8927 - AND (implicit)
8928 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8929 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008931A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008933 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008935Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8936indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02008937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008938For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8939"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8940requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8941is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
8942
8943 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8944 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8945 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8946 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
8947
8948To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8949and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
8950
8951 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8952 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8953 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8954 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
8955
8956 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8957 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8958 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8959 use_backend www if host_www
8960
8961It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8962expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8963be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8964the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
8965
8966 The following rule :
8967
8968 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8969 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8970
8971 Can also be written that way :
8972
8973 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8974
8975It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8976to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8977simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8978sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8979good use is the following :
8980
8981 With named ACLs :
8982
8983 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8984 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8985 monitor fail if site_dead
8986
8987 With anonymous ACLs :
8988
8989 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8990
8991See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
8992
8993
89947.3. Fetching samples
8995---------------------
8996
8997Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
8998against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
8999sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9000ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9001of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9002available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9003
9004This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9005Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9006compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9007deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9008
9009The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9010matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9011method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9012indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9013
9014As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9015when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9016mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9017the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9018ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9019
9020Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9021multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9022when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9023incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9024are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9025is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9026all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9027
9028Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9029 - name
9030 - name(arg1)
9031 - name(arg1,arg2)
9032
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009033Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9034of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9035is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9036was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9037has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9038unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9039
9040These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9041sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9042the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9043support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009045The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009047 lower Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed
9048 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9049 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009051 upper Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed
9052 after a string sample fetch function or after a transformation
9053 keyword returning a string type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009055 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for
9056 lookups and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within
9057 a certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9058 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9059 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9060
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009061 http_date([<offset>])
9062 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to
9063 a string representing this date in a format suitable for use
9064 in HTTP header fields. If an offset value is specified, then
9065 it is a number of seconds that is added to the date before the
9066 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit
9067 Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined
9068 with a positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the
9069 offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009070
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009071 map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9072 map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9073 map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9074 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type>
9075 matching method, and return the associated value converted to
9076 the type <output_type>. If the input value cannot be found in
9077 the <map_file>, the converter returns the <default_value>. If
9078 the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and acts
9079 as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is
9080 not set, it defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type>
9081 is not set, it defaults to "str". For convenience, the "map"
9082 keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a string to another
9083 string. The following array contains contains the list of all
9084 the map* converters.
9085
9086 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP
9087 addresses and strings are stored in trees, so the first of the
9088 finest match will be used. Other keys are stored in lists, so
9089 the first matching occurrence will be used.
9090
9091 +----+----------+---------+-------------+------------+
9092 | `-_ out | | | |
9093 | input `-_ | str | int | ip |
9094 | / match `-_ | | | |
9095 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9096 | str / str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip |
9097 | str / sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip |
9098 | str / dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip |
9099 | str / dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip |
9100 | str / end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip |
9101 | str / reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip |
9102 | int / int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip |
9103 | ip / ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip |
9104 +---------------+---------+-------------+------------+
9105
9106 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start
9107 with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and
9108 spaces are stripped. The key is then the first "word" (series
9109 of non-space/tabs characters), and the value is what follows
9110 this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9111 trailing spaces/tabs.
9112
9113 Example :
9114
9115 # this is a comment and is ignored
9116 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9117 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9118 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9119 | | | `----------- value
9120 | | `--------------------- middle spaces ignored
9121 | `---------------------------- key
9122 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091247.3.1. Fetching samples from internal states
9125--------------------------------------------
9126
9127A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9128not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9129"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9130The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9131
9132always_false : boolean
9133 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9134 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9135
9136always_true : boolean
9137 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9138 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9139
9140avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009141 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009142 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9143 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9144 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9145 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9146 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9147 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9148 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9149 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9150 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9151 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9152 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9153 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9154 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009156be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009157 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9158 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9159 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9160 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9161 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009163be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9165 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9166 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9167 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9168 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9169 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009170
9171 Example :
9172 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9173 backend dynamic
9174 mode http
9175 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9176 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009178connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9179 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
9180 still available in the backend, by totalizing the maximum amount of
9181 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9182 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009183
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009184 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009185 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009186 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009188 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9189 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009190
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009191 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009192 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009193 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009194 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9195 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009196 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009197 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009198
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009199 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9200 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009201 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009202 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009203
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009204date([<offset>]) : integer
9205 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9206 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9207 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9208 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009209 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9210
9211 Example :
9212
9213 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9214 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009215
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009216env(<name>) : string
9217 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9218 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9219 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9220 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9221 certain way.
9222
9223 Examples :
9224 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9225 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9226
9227 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9228 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009230fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9231 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009232 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9233 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009234 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9235 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9236 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9237 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9238 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009240fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9242 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9243 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9244 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9245 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9246 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9247 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9248 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009249
9250 Example :
9251 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9252 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9253 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9254 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9255 frontend mail
9256 bind :25
9257 mode tcp
9258 maxconn 100
9259 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9260 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9261 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9262 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009264nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9265 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9266 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9267 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009268 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9269 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9270 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009272queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009273 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9274 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9275 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009276 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9277 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9278 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9279 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9280 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9281
9282srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9284 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9285 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9286 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9287 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9288 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9289 methods.
9290
9291srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9292 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9293 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9294 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9295 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9296 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9297 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9298 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9299
9300srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9301 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9302 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
9303 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mosly
9304 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9305 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9306 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9307 overloading servers).
9308
9309 Example :
9310 # Redirect to a separate back
9311 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9312 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9313 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9314
9315table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9316 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9317 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9318
9319table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9320 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9321 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9322 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9323
9324
93257.3.2. Fetching samples at Layer 4
9326----------------------------------
9327
9328The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9329closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9330methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9331sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9332TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009333the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9334counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9335"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009336argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9337the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9338this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009339
9340be_id : integer
9341 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9342 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9343
9344dst : ip
9345 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9346 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9347 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9348 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9349 RFC 4291.
9350
9351dst_conn : integer
9352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9353 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9354 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9355 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9356 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9357 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9358 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9359 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009361dst_port : integer
9362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9363 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9364 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9365 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9366 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9367 an HTTP header.
9368
9369fe_id : integer
9370 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9371 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9372 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9373
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009374sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9375sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9376sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9377sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009378 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9379 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9380 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9381
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009382sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9383sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9384sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9385sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009386 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9387 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9388 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9389
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009390sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9391sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9392sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9393sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009394 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9395 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009396 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9397 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9398 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009399
9400 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9401 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009402 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9403 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9404 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009405 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9406 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9407
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009408sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9409sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9410sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9411sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009412 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9413 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9414
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009415sc_conn_cur(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9416sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9417sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9418sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009419 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9420 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9421 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9422
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009423sc_conn_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9424sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9425sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9426sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009427 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9428 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9429 See also src_conn_rate.
9430
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009431sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9432sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9433sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9434sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009435 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009436 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009437
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009438sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9439sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9440sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9441sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009442 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9443 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9444 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009445 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9446 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9447 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009448
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009449sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9450sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9451sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9452sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009453 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9454 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9455 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9456
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009457sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9458sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9459sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9460sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009461 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9462 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9463 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9464 src_http_err_rate.
9465
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009466sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9467sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9468sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9469sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009470 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9471 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9472 src_http_req_cnt.
9473
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009474sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9475sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9476sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9477sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009478 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9479 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9480 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9481 src_http_req_rate.
9482
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009483sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9484sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9485sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9486sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009488 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9489 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9490 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9491 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009492
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009493 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9494 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009495 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9496
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009497sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9498sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9499sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9500sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009501 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9502 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9503 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9504 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9505
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009506sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9507sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9508sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9509sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009510 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9511 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9512 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9513 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9514
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009515sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9516sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9517sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9518sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9520 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9521 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9522 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009523 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009524 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9525
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009526sc_sess_rate(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9527sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9528sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9529sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009530 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9531 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9532 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9533 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9534 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009535 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009537sc_tracked(<ctr>,[<table>]) : boolean
9538sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9539sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9540sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009541 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9542 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9543 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9544
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009545sc_trackers(<ctr>,[<table>]) : integer
9546sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9547sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9548sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009549 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9550 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009551 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009552 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9553 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009554 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9555 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9556 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558so_id : integer
9559 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9560 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9561 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563src : ip
9564 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9565 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9566 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9567 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9568 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9569 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9570 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009571
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009572 Example:
9573 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9574 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009576src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9577 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9578 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9579 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009580 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009582src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9583 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9584 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009585 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009586 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9589 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9590 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9591 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9592 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9593 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9594 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009595
9596 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9597 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9598 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9599 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009600 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009601 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9602 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009604src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009605 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009607 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009608 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009610src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009611 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9613 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009614 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009616src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9617 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
9618 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9619 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009620 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009622src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009623 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009625 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009626 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009628src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009629 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009630 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009631 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
9632 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009633 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9634 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9635 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9638 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
9639 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009640 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009641 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009644src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9645 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
9646 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9647 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9648 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009649 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9652 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9653 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9654 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009655 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9658 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
9659 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
9660 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009661 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009662 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9665 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9666 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9667 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009668 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009669 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
9670 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009671
9672 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009673 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009674 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009676src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9677 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
9678 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9679 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
9680 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009681 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
9682 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009684src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9685 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
9686 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009687 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
9688 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009689 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691src_port : integer
9692 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
9693 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
9694 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
9695 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009697src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9698 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009699 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9700 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
9701 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009702 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009704src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9705 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
9706 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
9707 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9708 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009709 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009711src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9712 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
9713 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
9714 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
9715 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
9716 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
9717 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
9718 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
9719 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009720
9721 Example :
9722 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
9723 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
9724 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
9725 listen ssh
9726 bind :22
9727 mode tcp
9728 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009729 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009730 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02009731 server local 127.0.0.1:22
9732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009733srv_id : integer
9734 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
9735 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
9736 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02009737
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01009738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097397.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 5
9740----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02009741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009742The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
9743closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
9744when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
9745usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
9746future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negociations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748ssl_c_ca_err : integer
9749 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9750 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
9751 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
9752 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
9753 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009755ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
9756 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9757 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
9758 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
9759 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761ssl_c_err : integer
9762 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9763 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
9764 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
9765 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
9766 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009768ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9770 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9771 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9772 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9773 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9774 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9775 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9776 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009778 ACL derivatives :
9779 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009781ssl_c_key_alg : string
9782 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9783 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9784 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009786 ACL derivatives :
9787 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009789ssl_c_notafter : string
9790 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
9791 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9792 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009794 ACL derivatives :
9795 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009797ssl_c_notbefore : string
9798 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
9799 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9800 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009802 ACL derivatives :
9803 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009805ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9807 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9808 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9812 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9813 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01009814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815 ACL derivatives :
9816 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009818ssl_c_serial : binary
9819 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
9820 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9821 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009823 ACL derivatives :
9824 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009826ssl_c_sha1 : binary
9827 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
9828 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
9829 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009831ssl_c_sig_alg : string
9832 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9833 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9834 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009836 ACL derivatives :
9837 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
9838
9839ssl_c_used : boolean
9840 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
9841 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009843ssl_c_verify : integer
9844 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
9845 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
9846 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
9847 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009849ssl_c_version : integer
9850 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
9851 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009853ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9854 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9855 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
9856 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9857 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009858 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009859 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9860 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9861 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863 ACL derivatives :
9864 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866ssl_f_key_alg : string
9867 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
9868 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
9869 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871 ACL derivatives :
9872 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009874ssl_f_notafter : string
9875 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9876 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9877 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009879 ACL derivatives :
9880 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009882ssl_f_notbefore : string
9883 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
9884 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
9885 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009887 ACL derivatives :
9888 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
9891 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9892 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
9893 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
9894 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9895 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
9896 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
9897 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
9898 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009900 ACL derivatives :
9901 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009903ssl_f_serial : binary
9904 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9905 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
9906 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908 ACL derivatives :
9909 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009911ssl_f_sig_alg : string
9912 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
9913 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9914 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009916 ACL derivatives :
9917 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009919ssl_f_version : integer
9920 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
9921 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9922
9923ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009924 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9925 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
9926 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
9927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009928 Example :
9929 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
9930 listen http-https
9931 bind :80
9932 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
9933 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
9934
9935ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
9936 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
9937 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9938
9939ssl_fc_alpn : string
9940 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negociation field from an
9941 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
9942 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
9943 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
9944 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
9945 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
9946 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
9947 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
9948 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
9949
9950 ACL derivatives :
9951 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009953ssl_fc_cipher : string
9954 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
9955 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009957 ACL derivatives :
9958 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009961 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
9962 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +01009963 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
9964 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
9965 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
9966 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009968ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
9969 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009970 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
9971 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
9972 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9973 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009975ssl_fc_npn : string
9976 This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an incoming connection
9977 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
9978 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
9979 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9980 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
9981 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
9982 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
9983 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985 ACL derivatives :
9986 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009988ssl_fc_protocol : string
9989 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
9990 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992 ACL derivatives :
9993 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
9994
9995ssl_fc_session_id : binary
9996 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
9997 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
9998 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
9999 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010001ssl_fc_sni : string
10002 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10003 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10004 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10005 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10006 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10007
10008 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10009 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10010 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010011 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10012 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010014 ACL derivatives :
10015 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10016 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10017 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10020 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10021 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010022
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100247.3.4. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
10025------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010027Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10028sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10029only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10030For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10031be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10032can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10033sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10034for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10035content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010037payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10038 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10039 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10040 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010042payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10043 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10044 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10045 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047req.len : integer
10048req_len : integer (deprecated)
10049 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10050 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10051 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10052 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10053 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10054 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10055 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10056 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010058req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10059 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010060 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10061 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10062 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10063 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010065 ACL alternatives :
10066 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010068req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10069 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10070 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10071 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10072 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010074 ACL alternatives :
10075 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079req.proto_http : boolean
10080req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10081 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10082 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10083 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10084 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10085 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10086 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10087 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010089 Example:
10090 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10091 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10092 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010093 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010095req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10096rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10097 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10098 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10099 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10100 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10101 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10102 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10103 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010105 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10106 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10107 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10108 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10109 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10110 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112 ACL derivatives :
10113 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115 Example :
10116 listen tse-farm
10117 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10118 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10119 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10120 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10121 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10122 persist rdp-cookie
10123 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10124 # This is only useful makes sense if
10125 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10126 stick-table type string size 204800
10127 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10128 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10129 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10132 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010134req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10135rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10136 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10137 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10138 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10139 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141 ACL derivatives :
10142 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010144req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10145req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10146 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10147 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10148 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10149 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10150 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10151 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10152 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154req.ssl_sni : string
10155req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10156 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10157 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10158 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10159 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10160 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10161 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10162 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10163 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10164 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10165 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10166 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10167 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169 ACL derivatives :
10170 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010172 Examples :
10173 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10174 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10175 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10176 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10177 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010179res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10180rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10181 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10182 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10183 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10184 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10185 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10186 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10187 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010189req.ssl_ver : integer
10190req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10191 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10192 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10193 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10194 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10195 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10196 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10197 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10198 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10199 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010201 ACL derivatives :
10202 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010203
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010204res.len : integer
10205 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10206 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10207 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10208 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10209 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10210 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10211 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10212 content inspection.
10213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010214res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10215 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010216 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10217 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10218 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10219 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10222 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10223 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10224 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10225 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229wait_end : boolean
10230 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10231 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10232 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10233 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10234 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10235 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10236 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10237 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010239 Examples :
10240 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10241 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10242 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010244 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10245 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10246 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10247 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10248 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10249 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10250 tcp-request content reject
10251
10252
102537.3.5. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
10254--------------------------------------
10255
10256It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10257This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10258data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10259its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10260HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10261content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10262to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10263more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10264response are indexed.
10265
10266base : string
10267 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10268 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10269 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10270 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10271 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10272 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10273 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10274 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10275
10276 ACL derivatives :
10277 base : exact string match
10278 base_beg : prefix match
10279 base_dir : subdir match
10280 base_dom : domain match
10281 base_end : suffix match
10282 base_len : length match
10283 base_reg : regex match
10284 base_sub : substring match
10285
10286base32 : integer
10287 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10288 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10289 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10290 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10291
10292base32+src : binary
10293 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10294 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10295 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10296 per-URL counters.
10297
10298req.cook([<name>]) : string
10299cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10300 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10301 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10302 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10303 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10304 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10305 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10306 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10307 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10308
10309 ACL derivatives :
10310 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10311 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10312 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10313 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10314 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10315 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10316 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10317 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010319req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10320cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10321 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10322 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010324req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10325cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10326 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10327 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10328 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10329 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10332 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10333 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10334 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10335 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10336 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10337 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10338 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10339 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10340 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10341 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010343hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10344 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10345 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10346 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10347 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
10348 unambiguouslly apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010350req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10351 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10352 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10353 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10354 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10355 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10356 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10357 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10358 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010360req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10361 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10362 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10363 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10364 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010366req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10367 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10368 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10369 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10370 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10371 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10372 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10373 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10374 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10375 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10376 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10377 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379 ACL derivatives :
10380 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10381 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10382 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10383 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10384 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10385 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10386 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10387 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10388
10389req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10390hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10391 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10392 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10393 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10394 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10395 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10396 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10397 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10398 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10399 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10400
10401req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10402hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10403 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10404 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10405 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10406 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10407 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10408 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10409 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10410 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10411
10412req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10413hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10414 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10415 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10416 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10417 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10418 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10419 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10420 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10421
10422http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10423 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10424 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10425 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10426 basic auth is supported.
10427
10428http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group
10429 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10430 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist, and
10431 whether that username belongs to one of the groups supplied in ACL patterns.
10432 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10433 basic auth is supported.
10434
10435 ACL derivatives :
10436 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : user group match
10437
10438http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010439 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10440 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010441 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10442 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010444method : integer + string
10445 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10446 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10447 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10448 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10449 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10450 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10451 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010453 ACL derivatives :
10454 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010456 Example :
10457 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10458 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10459 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010461path : string
10462 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10463 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10464 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10465 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10466 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10467 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10468 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470 ACL derivatives :
10471 path : exact string match
10472 path_beg : prefix match
10473 path_dir : subdir match
10474 path_dom : domain match
10475 path_end : suffix match
10476 path_len : length match
10477 path_reg : regex match
10478 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010480req.ver : string
10481req_ver : string (deprecated)
10482 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10483 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10484 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010486 ACL derivatives :
10487 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010489res.comp : boolean
10490 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10491 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10492 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010494res.comp_algo : string
10495 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10496 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10497 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010499res.cook([<name>]) : string
10500scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10501 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10502 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10503 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010505 ACL derivatives :
10506 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10509scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10510 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10511 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10512 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010514res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10515scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10516 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10517 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10518 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010520res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10521 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10522 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10523 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10524 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10525 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10526 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10527 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10528 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10529 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010531res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10532 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10533 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10534 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10535 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10536 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010538res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10539shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10540 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10541 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10542 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10543 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10544 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10545 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10546 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10547 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010549 ACL derivatives :
10550 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10551 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10552 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10553 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10554 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10555 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10556 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10557 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10558
10559res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10560shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10561 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10562 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10563 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10564 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10565 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10568shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10569 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10570 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10571 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10572 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10573 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10574 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10577shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10578 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10579 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10580 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10581 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10582 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10583 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010585res.ver : string
10586resp_ver : string (deprecated)
10587 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
10588 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590 ACL derivatives :
10591 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010593set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10594 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10595 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
10596 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
10597 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010599 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
10600 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604status : integer
10605 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
10606 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
10607 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010609url : string
10610 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
10611 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
10612 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
10613 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
10614 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
10615 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
10616 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010618 ACL derivatives :
10619 url : exact string match
10620 url_beg : prefix match
10621 url_dir : subdir match
10622 url_dom : domain match
10623 url_end : suffix match
10624 url_len : length match
10625 url_reg : regex match
10626 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628url_ip : ip
10629 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
10630 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
10631 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
10632 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
10633 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
10634 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10635 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637url_port : integer
10638 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
10639 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
10640 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
10641 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010643urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10644url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
10645 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
10646 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
10647 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
10648 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
10649 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
10650 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
10651 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
10652 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
10653 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655 ACL derivatives :
10656 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
10657 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
10658 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
10659 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
10660 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
10661 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
10662 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
10663 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010664
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666 Example :
10667 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
10668 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
10669 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
10670 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020010671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010672urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
10673 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
10674 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
10675 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020010676
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010010677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200106787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010679---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010681Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
10682every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010683order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010685ACL name Equivalent to Usage
10686---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010687FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010688HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010689HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
10690HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010691HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
10692HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
10693HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
10694HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
10695LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010696METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
10697METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
10698METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
10699METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
10700METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
10701METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010702RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010703REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010704TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010705WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
10706---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010010707
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107098. Logging
10710----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010711
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010712One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
10713provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
10714very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
10715provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
10716state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010717to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010718headers.
10719
10720In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
10721about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
10722send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
10723
10724 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
10725 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
10726 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
10727 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
10728 at the termination.
10729
10730The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
10731allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
10732as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
10733while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
10734real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
10735delay.
10736
10737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107388.1. Log levels
10739---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010740
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010741TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010742source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010743HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
10744in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
10745track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
10746syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
10747about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010748
10749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107508.2. Log formats
10751----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010752
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010753HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090010754and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
10755slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
10756options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010757
10758 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
10759 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
10760 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
10761 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
10762 extents.
10763
10764 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
10765 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
10766 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
10767 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
10768 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
10769
10770 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
10771 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
10772 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
10773 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
10774 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
10775
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010776 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
10777 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
10778 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
10779 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
10780
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010781 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
10782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010783Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
10784specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
10785field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
10786servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
10787always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
10788identifier.
10789
10790Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
10791 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
10792 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
10793 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
10794 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
10795
10796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107978.2.1. Default log format
10798-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010799
10800This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
10801as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
10802format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
10803
10804 Example :
10805 listen www
10806 mode http
10807 log global
10808 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10809
10810 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
10811 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
10812 (www/HTTP)
10813
10814 Field Format Extract from the example above
10815 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
10816 2 'Connect from' Connect from
10817 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
10818 4 'to' to
10819 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
10820 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
10821
10822Detailed fields description :
10823 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
10824 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
10825 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
10826 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
10827 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10828 and processed the connection.
10829 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
10830
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010831In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
10832"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
10833connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
10834
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010835It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
10836will eventually disappear.
10837
10838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108398.2.2. TCP log format
10840---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010841
10842The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
10843is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
10844information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
10845counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
10846emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
10847environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
10848the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
10849sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010850specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
10851not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
10852fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
10853marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010854
10855 Example :
10856 frontend fnt
10857 mode tcp
10858 option tcplog
10859 log global
10860 default_backend bck
10861
10862 backend bck
10863 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
10864
10865 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
10866 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
10867 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
10868
10869 Field Format Extract from the example above
10870 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
10871 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
10872 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
10873 4 frontend_name fnt
10874 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
10875 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
10876 7 bytes_read* 212
10877 8 termination_state --
10878 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
10879 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
10880
10881Detailed fields description :
10882 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010883 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
10884 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
10885 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
10886 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
10887 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010888
10889 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010010890 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
10891 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
10892 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010893
10894 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
10895 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
10896 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
10897 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
10898
10899 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
10900 and processed the connection.
10901
10902 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
10903 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
10904 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
10905 applications.
10906
10907 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
10908 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
10909 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
10910 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
10911 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
10912
10913 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
10914 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
10915 See "Timers" below for more details.
10916
10917 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
10918 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
10919 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
10920 "Timers" below for more details.
10921
10922 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
10923 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
10924 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
10925 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
10926 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
10927 details.
10928
10929 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
10930 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
10931 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
10932 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
10933 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
10934
10935 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
10936 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
10937 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
10938 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
10939 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
10940 for more details.
10941
10942 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010943 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010944 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
10945 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
10946 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010947 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010948
10949 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
10950 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
10951 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
10952 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
10953 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
10954 caused by a denial of service attack.
10955
10956 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
10957 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
10958 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
10959 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
10960 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
10961 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
10962 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
10963 denial of service attack.
10964
10965 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
10966 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
10967 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
10968 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
10969 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
10970 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
10971 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
10972 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
10973 be processed than on other servers.
10974
10975 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
10976 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
10977 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
10978 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
10979 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
10980 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
10981 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
10982 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
10983 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
10984 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
10985 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
10986 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10987 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10988
10989 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10990 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10991 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10992 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10993 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10994 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10995 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10996 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10997
10998 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10999 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11000 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11001 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11002 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11003 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11004 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11005 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11006 occurs.
11007
11008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110098.2.3. HTTP log format
11010----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011011
11012The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11013is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11014the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11015are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11016emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11017generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11018"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11019which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011020frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11021is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011022
11023Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11024slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11025with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11026
11027 Example :
11028 frontend http-in
11029 mode http
11030 option httplog
11031 log global
11032 default_backend bck
11033
11034 backend static
11035 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11036
11037 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11038 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11039 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011040 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011041
11042 Field Format Extract from the example above
11043 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11044 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11045 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11046 4 frontend_name http-in
11047 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11048 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11049 7 status_code 200
11050 8 bytes_read* 2750
11051 9 captured_request_cookie -
11052 10 captured_response_cookie -
11053 11 termination_state ----
11054 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11055 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11056 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11057 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11058 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011060
11061Detailed fields description :
11062 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011063 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11064 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11065 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11066 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11067 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011068
11069 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011070 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11071 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11072 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011073
11074 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11075 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11076 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11077 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11078 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11079
11080 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11081 and processed the connection.
11082
11083 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11084 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11085 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11086
11087 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11088 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11089 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11090 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11091 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11092 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11093
11094 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11095 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11096 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11097 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11098 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11099 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11100
11101 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11102 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11103 See "Timers" below for more details.
11104
11105 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11106 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11107 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11108 below for more details.
11109
11110 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11111 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11112 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11113 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11114 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11115 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11116 for more details.
11117
11118 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
11119 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
11120 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11121 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11122 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11123 details.
11124
11125 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11126 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11127 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11128
11129 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11130 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11131 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11132 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11133 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11134 overflowing.
11135
11136 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11137 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11138 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11139 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11140 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11141 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11142 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11143 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11144
11145 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11146 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11147 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11148 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11149 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11150 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11151 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11152 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11153
11154 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11155 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11156 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11157 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11158 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11159 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11160 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11161
11162 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011163 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011164 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11165 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11166 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011167 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011168 system.
11169
11170 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11171 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11172 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11173 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11174 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11175 caused by a denial of service attack.
11176
11177 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11178 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11179 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11180 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11181 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11182 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11183 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11184 denial of service attack.
11185
11186 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11187 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11188 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11189 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11190 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11191 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11192 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11193 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11194 processed than on other servers.
11195
11196 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11197 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11198 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11199 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11200 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11201 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11202 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11203 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11204 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11205 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11206 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11207 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11208 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11209
11210 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11211 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11212 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11213 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11214 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11215 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11216 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11217 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11218
11219 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11220 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11221 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11222 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11223 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11224 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11225 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11226 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11227 occurs.
11228
11229 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11230 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11231 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11232 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11233 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11234 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11235 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11236 cookies" below for more details.
11237
11238 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11239 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11240 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11241 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11242 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11243 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11244 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11245 and cookies" below for more details.
11246
11247 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11248 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11249 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11250 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11251 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11252 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11253 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11254 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11255
11256
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200112578.2.4. Custom log format
11258------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011259
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011260The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011261mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011262
11263HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11264Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11265separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11266prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11267
11268Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11269variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11270string formats ("Q").
11271
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011272If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011274less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11275the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11276
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011277Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011278In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceeded by another '%' resulting
11279in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011280
11281Flags are :
11282 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011283 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011284
11285 Example:
11286
11287 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11288 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11289
11290At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11291
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011292 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11293 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011294
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011295the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011296
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011297 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011298 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011299 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011300
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011301and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11302
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011303 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011304 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11305
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011306Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11307
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011308 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011309 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011310 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11311 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11312 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011313 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11314 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11315 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011316 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011317 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011318 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011319 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011320 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011321 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011322 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11323 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011324 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011325 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11326 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011327 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011328 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11329 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011330 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11331 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11332 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011333 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011334 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11335 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011336 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011337 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11338 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11339 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011340 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011341 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11342 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11343 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11344 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011345 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011346 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011347 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011348 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011349 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011350 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011351 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11352 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11353 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011354 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011355 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11356 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011357 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011358 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011359 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011360 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011361
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011362 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011363
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011364
113658.2.5. Error log format
11366-----------------------
11367
11368When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11369protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11370By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11371"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11372will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11373logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11374
11375The format looks like this :
11376
11377 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11378 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11379 Connection error during SSL handshake
11380
11381 Field Format Extract from the example above
11382 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11383 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11384 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11385 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11386 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11387
11388These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11389failures.
11390
11391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113928.3. Advanced logging options
11393-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011394
11395Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11396just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11397options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11398for more information about their usage.
11399
11400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114018.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11402------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011403
11404It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11405haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11406commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11407monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11408ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11409
11410 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11411 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11412 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11413 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11414
11415 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11416 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11417 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
11418 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
11419 such as other load-balancers.
11420
11421 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11422 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11423 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11424
11425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114268.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11427----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011428
11429The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11430what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11431or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11432"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11433just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11434log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11435after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11436is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11437with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11438with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11439
11440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114418.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11442------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011443
11444Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11445for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11446"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11447retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11448raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11449a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11450file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11451you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11452"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11453
11454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114558.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11456--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011457
11458Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11459multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11460them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11461"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11462logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11463error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11464and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11465too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11466useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11467alternative.
11468
11469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114708.4. Timing events
11471------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011472
11473Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11474reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11475the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11476frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11477mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11478
11479 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11480 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11481 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11482 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11483 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11484
11485 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11486 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11487 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11488 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11489 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11490
11491 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11492 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11493 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11494 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11495 connection never established.
11496
11497 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11498 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11499 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11500 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11501 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11502 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11503 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11504 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11505 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11506 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11507 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11508
11509 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11510 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11511 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11512 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
11513 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
11514
11515 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11516
11517 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11518 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11519 negative.
11520
11521These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11522protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11523that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011524due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011525close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11526session has been aborted on timeout.
11527
11528Most common cases :
11529
11530 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11531 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11532 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11533 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11534 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11535 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11536 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11537 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11538 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011539 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11540 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11541 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011542
11543 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11544 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11545 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11546 of ms on remote networks.
11547
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011548 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11549 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11550 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011551
11552 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11553 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11554 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11555 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11556 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11557 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11558 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11559 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11560 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11561 to the server until another one is released.
11562
11563Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11564
11565 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11566 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11567 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11568
11569 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11570 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11571 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11572
11573 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11574 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11575 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11576 flags.
11577
11578 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11579 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11580 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11581 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11582 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11583 the client connection was maintained open.
11584
11585 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
11586 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
11587 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
11588 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
11589
11590
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115918.5. Session state at disconnection
11592-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011593
11594TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
11595"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
115962-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
11597each of which has a special meaning :
11598
11599 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
11600 session to terminate :
11601
11602 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
11603
11604 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
11605 server explicitly refused it.
11606
11607 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
11608 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
11609 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
11610 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011611 (eg: cacheable cookie).
11612
11613 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
11614 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011615
11616 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
11617 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
11618 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
11619 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
11620 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
11621
11622 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
11623 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
11624 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
11625 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
11626 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
11627
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090011628 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
11629 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
11630
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011631 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
11632 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
11633 backup connections when going up.
11634
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020011635 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
11636
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011637 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
11638 send or receive data.
11639
11640 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
11641 send or receive data.
11642
11643 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
11644 with nothing left in the buffers.
11645
11646 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
11647
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010011648 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011649 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
11650
11651 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
11652 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
11653 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
11654 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
11655 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
11656
11657 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
11658 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
11659
11660 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
11661 server (HTTP only).
11662
11663 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
11664
11665 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
11666 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
11667 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
11668
11669 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
11670 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
11671 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
11672
11673 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
11674
11675 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
11676 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
11677
11678 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
11679 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
11680 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
11681
11682 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
11683 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020011684 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
11685 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011686
11687 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
11688 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
11689 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
11690 another server.
11691
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011692 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011693 server.
11694
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011695 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
11696 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
11697 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
11698 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11699
11700 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
11701 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
11702 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
11703 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
11704
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020011705 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
11706 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
11707 "use-server" rule).
11708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011709 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11710
11711 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
11712 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
11713
11714 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
11715
11716 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
11717 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
11718 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
11719
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011720 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
11721 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
11722 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
11723 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
11724 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
11725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011726 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
11727
11728 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
11729 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
11730
11731 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
11732
11733 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
11734
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011735The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
11736was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
11738starvation, attacks, etc...
11739
11740The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
11741alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
11742easier finding and understanding.
11743
11744 Flags Reason
11745
11746 -- Normal termination.
11747
11748 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
11749 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
11750 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
11751 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
11752
11753 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
11754 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
11755 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
11756 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
11757 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
11758 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011760 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11761 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011762 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011763
11764 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
11765 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
11766 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
11767
11768 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
11769 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
11770 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
11771 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
11772 the server takes too long to respond.
11773
11774 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
11775 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
11776 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
11777 long a time to respond.
11778
11779 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
11780 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
11781 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
11782 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
11783 and the client.
11784
11785 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
11786 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
11787 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
11788 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
11789 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
11790 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
11791
11792 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
11793 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011794 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
11795 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
11796 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
11797 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011798
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020011799 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
11800 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
11801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011802 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011803 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
11804 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
11805 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
11806 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
11807 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
11808
11809 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
11810 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
11811 503 or 504 here.
11812
11813 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
11814 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
11815 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
11816 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
11817 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
11818
11819 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
11820 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011821 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011822 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
11823 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
11824
11825 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
11826 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
11827 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
11828 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
11829 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
11830 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
11831 between haproxy and the server.
11832
11833 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
11834 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
11835 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
11836 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
11837 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
11838 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
11839 solution is to fix the application.
11840
11841 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
11842 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
11843 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
11844 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
11845 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
11846 external attacks.
11847
11848 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
11849 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011850 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011851 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
11852 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
11853
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011854 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
11855 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
11856 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020011857 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
11858 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011859
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011860 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
11861 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
11862 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
11863 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010011864 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
11865 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
11866 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
11867 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
11868 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011869
11870 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
11871 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
11872 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
11873 returned an HTTP 403 error.
11874
11875 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
11876 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
11877 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
11878 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
11879
11880 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
11881 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
11882 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
11883 only be solved by proper system tuning.
11884
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011885The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
11886persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
11887important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
11888re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
11889
11890 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
11891
11892 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11893 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
11894 set on a GET request.
11895
11896 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
11897 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011898 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020011899 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
11900
11901 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
11902 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
11903 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
11904
11905 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
11906 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
11907 already got a cookie.
11908
11909 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11910 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
11911 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
11912 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
11913 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
11914
11915 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
11916 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11917 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11918
11919 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
11920 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
11921 new cookie was inserted in the response.
11922
11923 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
11924 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
11925
11926 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
11927 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
11928 then advertised in the response.
11929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119318.6. Non-printable characters
11932-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011933
11934In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
11935consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
11936converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
11937prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
11938being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
11939escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
11940is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
11941'}' when logging headers.
11942
11943Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
11944issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
11945containing spaces is "User-Agent".
11946
11947Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
11948the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
11949performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
11950
11951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119528.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
11953---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011954
11955Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
11956achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011957section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011958cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
11959the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
11960the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011961locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011962not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
11963user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
11964a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
11965wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
11966
11967 Examples :
11968 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
11969 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
11970
11971 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
11972 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
11973
11974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119758.8. Capturing HTTP headers
11976---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011977
11978Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
11979proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
11980the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
11981server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
11982
11983Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
11984response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011985section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011986
11987It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011988time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
11989appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011990are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
11991and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
11992follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
11993request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
11994in the logs.
11995
11996 Example :
11997 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
11998 listen proxy-out
11999 mode http
12000 option httplog
12001 option logasap
12002 log global
12003 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12004
12005 # log the name of the virtual server
12006 capture request header Host len 20
12007
12008 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12009 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12010
12011 # log the beginning of the referrer
12012 capture request header Referer len 20
12013
12014 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12015 capture response header Server len 20
12016
12017 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12018 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12019
12020 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12021 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12022
12023 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12024 capture response header Via len 20
12025
12026 # log the URL location during a redirection
12027 capture response header Location len 20
12028
12029 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12030 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12031 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12032 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12033 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12034
12035 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12036 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12037 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12038 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012039 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012040
12041 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12042 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12043 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12044 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12045 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012046 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012047
12048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120498.9. Examples of logs
12050---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012051
12052These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12053them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12054reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12055
12056 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12057 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12058 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12059
12060 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12061 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12062
12063 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12064 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12065 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12066
12067 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12068 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12069
12070 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12071 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12072 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12073
12074 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012075 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012076 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12077 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12078
12079 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12080 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12081 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12082
12083 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12084 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012085 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012086 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12087 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12088 to return the 502 and not the server.
12089
12090 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012091 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012092
12093 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12094 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12095 Nothing was sent to any server.
12096
12097 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12098 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12099
12100 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12101 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12102 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12103 send a 408 return code to the client.
12104
12105 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12106 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12107
12108 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12109 5 seconds ("c----").
12110
12111 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12112 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012113 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012114
12115 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012116 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012117 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12118 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12119 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12120 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12121 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012122
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121249. Statistics and monitoring
12125----------------------------
12126
12127It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12128mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12129CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12130Unix socket.
12131
12132
121339.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012134---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012135
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012136The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12137page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012139 0. pxname: proxy name
12140 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12141 for server)
12142 2. qcur: current queued requests
12143 3. qmax: max queued requests
12144 4. scur: current sessions
12145 5. smax: max sessions
12146 6. slim: sessions limit
12147 7. stot: total sessions
12148 8. bin: bytes in
12149 9. bout: bytes out
12150 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012151 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012152 12. ereq: request errors
12153 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012154 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012155 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12156 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012157 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012158 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12159 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12160 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12161 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12162 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12163 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12164 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12165 25. qlimit: queue limit
12166 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12167 27. iid: unique proxy id
12168 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12169 29. throttle: warm up status
12170 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12171 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012172 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012173 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12174 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12175 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012176 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012177 UNK -> unknown
12178 INI -> initializing
12179 SOCKERR -> socket error
12180 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12181 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12182 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12183 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12184 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12185 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12186 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12187 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12188 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12189 disable-on-404
12190 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12191 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12192 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012193 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12194 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012195 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12196 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12197 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12198 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12199 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12200 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012201 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12202 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12203 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12204 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012205 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12206 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012207 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12208 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12209 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012210 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012211
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122139.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012214-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012215
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012216The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12217necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12218A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12219issuing commands by hand :
12220
12221 global
12222 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12223 stats timeout 2m
12224
12225It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12226the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12227never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12228situations :
12229
12230 global
12231 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12232 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12233 stats timeout 2m
12234
12235To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12236swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12237to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12238syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12239
12240 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12241 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12242
12243The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12244script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12245for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12246
12247The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12248that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12249editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12250(eg: watch a counter).
12251
12252The socket supports two operation modes :
12253 - interactive
12254 - non-interactive
12255
12256The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12257this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12258sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12259mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12260commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12261example :
12262
12263 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12264
12265The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12266entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12267for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12268sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12269"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12270after processing the last command of the same line.
12271
12272For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12273"prompt" command :
12274
12275 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12276 prompt
12277 > show info
12278 ...
12279 >
12280
12281Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12282delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12283that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12284parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012285
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012286It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12287on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12288own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012289
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012290The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12291If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12292all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12293it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12294
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012295add map <map> <key> <value>
12296 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12297 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
12298 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation.
12299
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012300clear counters
12301 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12302 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12303 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12304 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12305 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12306
12307clear counters all
12308 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12309 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12310 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12311
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012312clear map <map>
12313 Remove all entries from the map <map>.
12314
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012315clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12316 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12317
12318 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12319 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12320 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12321 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12322 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12323 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12324
12325 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12326
12327 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12328 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12329 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12330 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12331 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12332 the ACLs :
12333
12334 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12335 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12336 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12337 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12338 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12339 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12340
12341 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012342 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12343 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012344
12345 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012346 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012347 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012348 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12349 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12350 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12351 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012352
12353 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12354
12355 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012356 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012357 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12358 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012359 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12360 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12361 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012362
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012363enable agent <backend>/<server>
12364 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12365
12366 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12367 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12368 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12369 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12370 re-enabled using enable agent.
12371
12372 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12373 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12374 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12375 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12376 otherwise unchanged.
12377
12378 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12379 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12380 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12381
12382 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12383 level "admin".
12384
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012385del map <map> <key>
12386 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
12387
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012388disable frontend <frontend>
12389 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12390 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12391 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12392 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12393 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12394 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12395 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12396 on the stats page.
12397
12398 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12399 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12400
12401 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12402 level "admin".
12403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012404disable server <backend>/<server>
12405 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12406 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12407 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12408 during the maintenance.
12409
12410 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12411 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12412
12413 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012414 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012415
12416 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12417 level "admin".
12418
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012419enable agent <backend>/<server>
12420 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12421
12422 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12423 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12424
12425 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12426 level "admin".
12427
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012428enable frontend <frontend>
12429 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12430 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12431 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12432 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12433 which was disabled.
12434
12435 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12436 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12437
12438 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12439 level "admin".
12440
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012441enable server <backend>/<server>
12442 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12443 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12444
12445 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012446 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012447
12448 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12449 level "admin".
12450
12451get weight <backend>/<server>
12452 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12453 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12454 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12455 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12456 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012457 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012458
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012459help
12460 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12461 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012462
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012463prompt
12464 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12465 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12466 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12467 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12468 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12469 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12470 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12471 command.
12472
12473quit
12474 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012475
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012476set map <map> <key> <value>
12477 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. The new value
12478 is <value>.
12479
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012480set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012481 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12482 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12483 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12484 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12485 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012486 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12487 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12488
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012489set maxconn global <maxconn>
12490 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12491 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12492 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12493 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12494 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12495 setting.
12496
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012497set rate-limit connections global <value>
12498 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12499 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12500 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12501 is passed in number of connections per second.
12502
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012503set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12504 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12505 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012506 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12507 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012508
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012509set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012510 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
12511 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
12512 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
12513 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012514 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
12515 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012517set timeout cli <delay>
12518 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
12519 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
12520 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
12521
12522set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
12523 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
12524 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090012525 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
12526 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
12527 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
12528 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
12529 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
12530 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
12531 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
12532 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
12533 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
12534 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
12535 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
12536 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
12537 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012538
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012539show errors [<iid>]
12540 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
12541 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012542 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
12543 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
12544 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012545
12546 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
12547 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
12548 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
12549 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
12550 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
12551 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
12552 are reported too.
12553
12554 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
12555 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
12556 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
12557 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
12558 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
12559 code.
12560
12561 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
12562 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
12563 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
12564 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
12565 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
12566 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
12567 line.
12568
12569 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012570 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12571 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012572 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
12573 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
12574
12575 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
12576 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
12577 00038 Location: blah\r\n
12578 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
12579 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
12580 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
12581 00204+ minal\r\n
12582 00211 \r\n
12583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012584 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010012585 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
12586 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
12587 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
12588 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
12589 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
12590 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012591
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012592show info
12593 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
12594
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012595show map [<map>]
12596 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
12597 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped.
12598
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012599show sess
12600 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020012601 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
12602 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12603
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010012604show sess <id>
12605 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
12606 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12607 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
12608 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
12609 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010012610 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
12611 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
12612 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012613
12614show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
12615 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
12616 possible to dump only selected items :
12617 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
12618 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
12619 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
12620 for example:
12621 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
12622 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
12623 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
12624
12625 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012626 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
12627 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012628 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
12629 Release_date: 2009/09/23
12630 Nbproc: 1
12631 Process_num: 1
12632 (...)
12633
12634 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
12635 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
12636 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
12637 (...)
12638 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
12639
12640 $
12641
12642 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
12643 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
12644 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
12645 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012646 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012647
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012648show table
12649 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
12650 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
12651 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
12652 entries currently in use.
12653
12654 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012655 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012656 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
12657 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012658
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012659show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012660 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
12661 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
12662 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012663 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
12664
12665 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
12666 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
12667 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
12668 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
12669 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
12670
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012671 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12672 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12673 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12674 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12675 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12676 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12677
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012678
12679 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012680 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
12681 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012682
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012683 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012684 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012685 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012686 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12687 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12688 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12689 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012690
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012691 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012692 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012693 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12694 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012695
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012696 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
12697 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012698 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012699 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12700 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012701
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012702 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
12703 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090012704 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090012705 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12706 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
12707
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012708 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
12709 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
12710 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
12711 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
12712 time goes, the average event rate drops.
12713
12714 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
12715 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
12716 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012717 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
12718 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012719 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
12720 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020012721
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012722shutdown frontend <frontend>
12723 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
12724 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
12725 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
12726 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
12727 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
12728 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
12729 once it is terminated.
12730
12731 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12732 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12733
12734 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12735 level "admin".
12736
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020012737shutdown session <id>
12738 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
12739 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
12740 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
12741 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
12742 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
12743 flag in the logs.
12744
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020012745shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
12746 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
12747 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
12748 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
12749 'K' flag in the logs.
12750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012751/*
12752 * Local variables:
12753 * fill-column: 79
12754 * End:
12755 */